flash/nor/stm32f1x: Add support for GD32F1x0/3x0
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2521 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2522 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2526 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2527 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2528 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2529 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2530 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2531 and initially asserted reset signals.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2535 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2536 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2537 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2538 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2539 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2540 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2541 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2542 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2543 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2544 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2545
2546 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2547 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2548 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2549 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2550 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2551 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2552
2553 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2554 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2555 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2556 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2557 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2558 are always driven by the FTDI.
2559
2560 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2561 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2562 @var{name}.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2566 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item @option{0}, drive low
2569 @item @option{1}, drive high
2570 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2571 @end itemize
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2575 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2579 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2580
2581 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2582 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2583 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2584 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2587 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2592 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2593
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2597 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2598 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2599 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2600
2601 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2604 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2605 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2606 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2607 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2608 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2609 @end itemize
2610
2611 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2612 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2613 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2614 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2615 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2616 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2617 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2618 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2619
2620 FT232R
2621 @itemize @minus
2622 @item bit 7 - RI
2623 @item bit 6 - DCD
2624 @item bit 5 - DSR
2625 @item bit 4 - DTR
2626 @item bit 3 - CTS
2627 @item bit 2 - RTS
2628 @item bit 1 - RXD
2629 @item bit 0 - TXD
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2637 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2641 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2642 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2643 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2647 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2648 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2652 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2656 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2660 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2664 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2668 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2672 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2676 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2677 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2678 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2679 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2680 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2681 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2682 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2683 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2684 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2690 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2691 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2692 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2693
2694 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2695 processors which are being simulated.
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2698 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2699 sockets instead of TCP.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2703 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2704 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2708 something like:
2709
2710 @example
2711 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2712 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2713 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2714 @end example
2715
2716 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2717 named mysocket:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang_port 0
2722 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2727 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2728 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2729 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2732 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2733 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2734 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2735 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2736 @end deffn
2737
2738 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2739 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2740 default values are used.
2741 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2742 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2743 @example
2744 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2745 @end example
2746 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2747 @example
2748 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2749 @end example
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2753 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2754 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2755 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2756 target board.
2757
2758 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2759 @example
2760 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2761 reset_config srst_only
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2766 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2767 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2768 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2772 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2773 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2774 @end deffn
2775
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2779 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2780 This has one driver-specific command:
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2783 Display either the address of the I/O port
2784 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2785 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2786 This is a write-once setting.
2787 @end deffn
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2791 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2792 transports.
2793
2794 @quotation Compatibility Note
2795 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2796 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2797 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2798 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2799 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2800 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2801 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2802 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2803 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2804 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2805 @end quotation
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2808 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2809 states.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2812 Display free device internal memory.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2815 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2816 command version.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2819 Display the device configuration.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2822 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2823 power state.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2826 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2829 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2830 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2831 IP configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2834 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2835 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2838 Reset the current configuration.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2841 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2844 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2845 pairs.
2846
2847 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2848 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2849 @example
2850 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2851 @end example
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2854 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2855 pairs.
2856
2857 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2858 @example
2859 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2860 77a90000
2861 @end example
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2864 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2865 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2866 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2867 the serial number instead, if possible.
2868
2869 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2872 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2873 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2874
2875 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2876 @end deffn
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2880 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2881 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2882 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2883 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2884 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2885 configuration script.
2886
2887 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2888 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2889 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2890 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2891 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2892
2893 Known limitations:
2894 @itemize @bullet
2895 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2896 and 2.7 MHz.
2897 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2898 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2899 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2900 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2901 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2902 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2903 communications with the target.
2904 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2905 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2906 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2907 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2908 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2909 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2910 @end itemize
2911
2912 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2913 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2914 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2918 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2919 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2923 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2924 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2925 target as a side-effect.
2926 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2930 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2931 version, and target voltage.
2932 @end deffn
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2936 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2937 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2938 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2939 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2940
2941 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2942 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2943 This is a write-once setting.
2944 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2945
2946 @itemize @minus
2947 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2948 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2949 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2950 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2951 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2952 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2953 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2954 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2955 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2956 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2957 some versions of
2958 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2959 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2960 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2961 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2962 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2963 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2964 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2965 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2966 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2967 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2968 @end itemize
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2972 Display either the address of the I/O port
2973 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2974 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2975 This is a write-once setting.
2976
2977 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2978 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2979 you may encounter a problem.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2983 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2984 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2985 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2986 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2987 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2988
2989 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2990 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2991 @quotation Tip
2992 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2993 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2994 @example
2995 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2996 > adapter speed 500
2997 @end example
2998 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2999 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3000 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3001 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3002 large set of samples.
3003 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3004 @example
3005 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3006 @end example
3007 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3008 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3009
3010 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3011 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3012 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3013 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3014 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3015 be conservative.
3016 @end quotation
3017 @end deffn
3018
3019 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3020 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3021 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3025 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3026
3027 @example
3028 adapter driver parport
3029 parport_port 0x278
3030 parport_cable wiggler
3031 @end example
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3035 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3036 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3037 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3038 @end deffn
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3042 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3046 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3050 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3051
3052 @quotation Note
3053 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3054 which are not currently documented here.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @anchor{hla_interface}
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3060 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3061 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3062 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3063
3064 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3065 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3066 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3067 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3068 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3069 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3070
3071 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3072 Currently Not Supported.
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3076 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3080 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3084 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3088 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3089 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3090
3091 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3092 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3093 ST-LINK server software module}.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3097 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3098 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3099 @end deffn
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3104 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3105 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3106 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3107
3108 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3109 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3110 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3111 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3114 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3115
3116 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3117 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3118 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3119
3120 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3121 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3122 ST-LINK server software module}.
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3128 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3137 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3141 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3145 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3146 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3147 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3148 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3149
3150 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3151 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3152 XDS110 found will be used.
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3156 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3157 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3158 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3159 @end deffn
3160
3161 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3162 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3163 version).
3164 @end deffn
3165 @end deffn
3166
3167 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3168 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3169 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3170 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3171 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3172
3173 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3174
3175 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3176 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3177
3178 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3179 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3180
3181 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3182
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3187 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3188 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3189
3190 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3191 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3192 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3193 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3194 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3195 configuration on exit.
3196
3197 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3198 pinout.
3199
3200 @end deffn
3201
3202 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3203 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3204 of the one which is most popular.
3205
3206 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3207
3208 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3209 pinout.
3210
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213
3214 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3215 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3216 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3217
3218 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221
3222 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3223 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3224 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3225
3226 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229
3230 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3231 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3232 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3233
3234 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3235 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3236 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3237
3238 @itemize @minus
3239 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3240 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3241 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3242 @end itemize
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3246 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3247 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3248 @end deffn
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251
3252 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3253 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3254 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3255 DPI server interface.
3256
3257 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3258 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3259 @end deffn
3260
3261 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3262 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3263 @end deffn
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266
3267 @section Transport Configuration
3268 @cindex Transport
3269 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3270 and the debug adapter you are using,
3271 several transports may be available to
3272 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3273 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3274 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3275 version of OpenOCD.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3279 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3280
3281 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3282 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3283 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3284 adapter's driver).
3285
3286 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3287 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3288 supported by the debug adapter.
3289
3290 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3291 transport, if any.
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294 @subsection JTAG Transport
3295 @cindex JTAG
3296 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3297 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3298 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3299 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3300 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3301 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3302
3303 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3304 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3305 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3306 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3307 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3308
3309 @subsection SWD Transport
3310 @cindex SWD
3311 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3312 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3313 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3314 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3315 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3316 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3317 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3318
3319 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3320 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3321 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3322 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3323 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3324
3325 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3326 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3327 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3328 expected to change.
3329 @end deffn
3330 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3331 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3332 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3333 No parameters: displays current settings.
3334 @end deffn
3335
3336 @subsection SPI Transport
3337 @cindex SPI
3338 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3339 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3340 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3341 solution for flash programming.
3342
3343 @anchor{swimtransport}
3344 @subsection SWIM Transport
3345 @cindex SWIM
3346 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3347 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3348 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3349 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3350
3351 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3352
3353 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3354
3355 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3356 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3357 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3358 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3359 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3360
3361 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3362 @section JTAG Speed
3363 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3364 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3365 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3366 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3367 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3368 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3369 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3370 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3371 power management software that may be active.
3372
3373 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3374 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3375 target event handler.
3376 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3377 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3378 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3379 sets up those clocks).
3380 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3381 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3382 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3383 in the target config file.
3384 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3385 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3386 config file instead.
3387 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3388 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3389 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3390
3391 @example
3392 jtag_rclk 3000
3393 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3394 @end example
3395
3396 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3397 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3398 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3399 may not be the fastest solution.
3400
3401 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3402 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3403 which support adaptive clocking.
3404
3405 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3406 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3407 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3408 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3409 than the speed specified.
3410
3411 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3412 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3413 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3414 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3415
3416 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3417 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3418 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3419 JTAG clocking after setup.
3420 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3421 If the interface device can not
3422 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3423 @end deffn
3424
3425 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3426 @cindex adaptive clocking
3427 @cindex RTCK
3428 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3429 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3430 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3431 @example
3432 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3433 jtag_rclk 3000
3434 @end example
3435 @end defun
3436
3437 @node Reset Configuration
3438 @chapter Reset Configuration
3439 @cindex Reset Configuration
3440
3441 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3442 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3443 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3444 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3445 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3446 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3447 Please see the various board files for examples.
3448
3449 @quotation Note
3450 To maintainers and integrators:
3451 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3452 Normally the board configuration file
3453 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3454 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3455
3456 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3457 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3458 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3459 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3460 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3461 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3462 @end quotation
3463
3464 @section Types of Reset
3465
3466 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3467 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3468 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3469
3470 @itemize @bullet
3471 @item
3472 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3473 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3474 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3475 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3476 @item
3477 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3478 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3479 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3480 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3481 @item
3482 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3483 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3484 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3485 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3486 @item
3487 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3488 several other types of reset.
3489 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3490 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3491 There may be individual module resets.
3492 @end itemize
3493
3494 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3495 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3496 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3497 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3498 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3499 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3500 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3501 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3502 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3503
3504 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3505 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3506
3507 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3508 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3509 common issues are:
3510
3511 @itemize @bullet
3512
3513 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3514 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3515 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3516 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3517 when either of those signals is not connected.
3518 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3519 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3520 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3521 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3522
3523 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3524 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3525 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3526 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3527
3528 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3529 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3530 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3531 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3532 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3533 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3534 hardware debouncing.
3535 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3536 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3537
3538 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3539 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3540 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3541 to use push/pull output drivers.
3542 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3543 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3544 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3545 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3546
3547 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3548 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3549 issues (not limited to errata).
3550 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3551 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3552 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3553 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3554 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3555 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3556 @end itemize
3557
3558 There can also be other issues.
3559 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3560 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3561 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3562 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3563 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3564 Agreement (NDA).
3565
3566 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3567 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3568 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3569
3570 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3571 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3572
3573 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3574
3575 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3576 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3577 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3578 allowing it to be deasserted.
3579 @end deffn
3580
3581 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3582 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3583 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3584 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3585 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3586 @end deffn
3587
3588 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3589 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3590 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3591 allowing it to be deasserted.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3595 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3596 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3597 @end deffn
3598
3599 @anchor{reset_config}
3600 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3601 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3602 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3603 configuration scripts.
3604
3605 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3606 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3607 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3608 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3609 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3610 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3611 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3612 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3613
3614 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3615 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3616 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3617 -- may be specified at a time.
3618 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3619 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3620 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3621 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3622 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3623
3624 @itemize
3625 @item
3626 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3627 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3628 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3629 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3630 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3631
3632 @quotation Tip
3633 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3634 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3635 @end quotation
3636
3637 @item
3638 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3639 signal implementations.
3640 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3641 indicating everything behaves normally.
3642 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3643 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3644 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3645 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3646 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3647 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3648 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3649
3650 @item
3651 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3652 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3653 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3654 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3655 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3656 while SRST is asserted.
3657 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3658 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3659
3660 @item
3661 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3662 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3663 is required to use this option.
3664 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3665 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3666 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3667 be asserted before any target connection.
3668 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3669 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3670 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3671 @end itemize
3672
3673 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3674 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3675 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3676 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3677 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3678
3679 @itemize
3680 @item
3681 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3682 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3683 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3684 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3685
3686 @item
3687 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3688 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3689 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3690 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3691 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3692 @end itemize
3693 @end deffn
3694
3695 @section Custom Reset Handling
3696 @cindex events
3697
3698 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3699 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3700 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3701 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3702 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3703 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3704
3705 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3706 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3707 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3708 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3709 want to reset everything at once.
3710
3711 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3712 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3713 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3714 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3715 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3716 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3717 needs special attention.
3718
3719 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3720 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3721 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3722 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3723 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3724 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3725 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3726 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3727 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3728
3729 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3730 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3731 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3732 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3733 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3734
3735 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3736 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3737 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3738 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3739 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3740 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3741 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3742 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3743 or potentially some other value.
3744
3745 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3746 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3747 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3748 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3749 (or their associated targets)
3750 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3751
3752 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3753 they return.
3754 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3755 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3756 @end deffn
3757
3758 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3759 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3760 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3761 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3762 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3763 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3764 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3765 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3766 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3767 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3768 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3772 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3773 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3774 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3775 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3776 @end deffn
3777
3778
3779 @node TAP Declaration
3780 @chapter TAP Declaration
3781 @cindex TAP declaration
3782 @cindex TAP configuration
3783
3784 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3785 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3786
3787 @itemize @bullet
3788 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3789 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3790 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3791 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3792 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3793 start running that code.
3794 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3795 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3796 and missing connections.
3797 @end itemize
3798
3799 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3800 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3801 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3802 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3803 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3804
3805 @section Scan Chains
3806 @cindex scan chain
3807
3808 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3809 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3810 They also need to be added to
3811 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3812 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3813 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3814 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3815 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3816 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3817 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3818 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3819
3820 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3821 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3822 command, presented in the next chapter.
3823 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3824 debugging targets.)
3825 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3826
3827 @verbatim
3828 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3829 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3830 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3831 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3832 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3833 @end verbatim
3834
3835 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3836 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3837 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3838 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3839 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3840 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3841 until they are told to do so.
3842
3843 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3844 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3845 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3846 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3847
3848 @example
3849 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3850 @end example
3851
3852 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3853 by a given chip.
3854 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3855 and so forth.
3856 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3857 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3858 both inside a single chip and between them.
3859 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3860
3861 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3862 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3863 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3864 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3865 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3866 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3867 includes commands something like this:
3868
3869 @example
3870 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3871 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3872 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3873 @end example
3874
3875 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3876 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3877 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3878
3879 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3880 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3881 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3882 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3883 @example
3884 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3885 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3886 @}
3887 @end example
3888 @end deffn
3889
3890 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3891 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3892 and their status.
3893 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3894 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3895 but systems with a JTAG router can
3896 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3897 @end deffn
3898
3899 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3900 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3901
3902 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3903 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3904
3905 @section TAP Names
3906 @cindex dotted name
3907
3908 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3909 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3910 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3911 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3912 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3913 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3914 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3915 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3916
3917 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3918 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3919 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3920
3921 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3922
3923 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3924 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3925 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3926
3927 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3928 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3929 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3930 overridable.
3931
3932 @cindex TAP naming convention
3933 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3934 and should follow this convention:
3935
3936 @itemize @bullet
3937 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3938 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3939 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3940 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3941 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3942 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3943 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3944 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3945 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3946 with a single TAP;
3947 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3948 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3949 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3950 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3951 @end itemize
3952
3953 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3954
3955 @itemize @bullet
3956 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3957 @*The length in bits of the
3958 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3959 @end itemize
3960
3961 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3962
3963 @itemize @bullet
3964 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3965 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3966 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3967 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3968 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3969 (the TAP is linked in).
3970 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3971 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3972 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3973 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3974 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3975 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3976 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3977 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3978 values that were found but not included in the list.
3979
3980 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3981 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3982 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3983 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3984 hardware to find these values.
3985 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3986 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3987 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3988 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3989 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3990 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3991 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3992 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3993 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3994 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3995 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3996 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3997 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3998 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3999 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4000 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4001 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4002 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4003 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4004 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4005 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4006 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4007 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4008 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4009 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4010 @end itemize
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @section Other TAP commands
4014
4015 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4016 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4017 @end deffn
4018
4019 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4020 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4021 At this writing this TAP attribute
4022 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4023 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4024 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4025 See the next section for information about the available events.
4026
4027 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4028 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4029 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @section TAP Events
4033 @cindex events
4034 @cindex TAP events
4035
4036 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4037 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4038 The other applies to debugger targets,
4039 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4040
4041 The TAP events currently defined are:
4042
4043 @itemize @bullet
4044 @item @b{post-reset}
4045 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4046 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4047 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4048 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4049 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4050
4051 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4052 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4053 of any particular target.
4054 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4055 @item @b{setup}
4056 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4057 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4058 @item @b{tap-disable}
4059 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4060 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4061 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4062 @item @b{tap-enable}
4063 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4064 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4065 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4066 @end itemize
4067
4068 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4069 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4070 contents to be accurate), you might:
4071
4072 @example
4073 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4074 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4075 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4076 @}
4077 @end example
4078
4079
4080 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4081 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4082 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4083 @cindex jrc
4084
4085 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4086 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4087 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4088 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4089 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4090
4091 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4092 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4093 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4094 be visible.
4095 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4096 ignores, such as:
4097
4098 @itemize
4099 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4100 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4101 TAPs receive new instructions.
4102 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4103 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4104 @end itemize
4105
4106 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4107 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4108 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4109 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4110
4111 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4112 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4113
4114 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4115 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4116 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4117 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4118 should define TAP event handlers using
4119 code that looks something like this:
4120
4121 @example
4122 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4123 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4124 @}
4125 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4126 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4127 @}
4128 @end example
4129
4130 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4131
4132 @example
4133 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4134 @end example
4135
4136 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4137 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4138 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4139 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4140
4141 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4142 If necessary, disables the tap
4143 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4144 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4145 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4146 and "0" if it is disabled.
4147 @end deffn
4148
4149 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4150 If necessary, enables the tap
4151 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4152 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4153 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4154 and "0" if it is disabled.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4158 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4159 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4160 and "0" if it is disabled.
4161
4162 @quotation Note
4163 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4164 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4165 @end quotation
4166 @end deffn
4167
4168 @anchor{autoprobing}
4169 @section Autoprobing
4170 @cindex autoprobe
4171 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4172
4173 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4174 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4175 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4176 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4177
4178 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4179 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4180 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4181 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4182 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4183 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4184 right when they come out of reset).
4185
4186 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4187
4188 @example
4189 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4190 reset_config trst_and_srst
4191 jtag_rclk 8
4192 @end example
4193
4194 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4195 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4196
4197 @enumerate
4198 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4199 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4200 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4201 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4202 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4203 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4204 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4205 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4206 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4207 that is discovered.
4208 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4209 register, it will report it.
4210 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4211 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4212 @end enumerate
4213
4214 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4215 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4216 that's a bit more complex:
4217
4218 @example
4219 clock speed 8 kHz
4220 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4221 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4222 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4223 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4224 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4225 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4226 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4227 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4228 @end example
4229
4230 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4231 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4232 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4233 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4234 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4235 and so forth.
4236
4237 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4238 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4239 @cindex DAP declaration
4240
4241 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4242 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4243 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4244 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4245 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4246
4247 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4248
4249 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4250 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4251 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4252 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4253 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4254
4255 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4256
4257 @itemize @bullet
4258 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4259 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4260 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4261 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4262 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4263 @end itemize
4264 @end deffn
4265
4266 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4267 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4268 for TCL scripting.
4269 @end deffn
4270
4271 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4272 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4273 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4274 @end deffn
4275
4276 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4277 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4278 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4279 initialization, too.
4280 @end deffn
4281
4282 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4283
4284 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4285 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4286 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4290 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4291 @end deffn
4292
4293 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4294 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4295 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4296 or set a new value @var{value}.
4297 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4298 @end deffn
4299
4300 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4301 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4305 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4306 value @var{value}.
4307
4308 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4309 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4310 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4311
4312 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4313 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4317 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4318 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4322 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4323 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4324 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4325 @end deffn
4326
4327 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4328 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4329
4330 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4331 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4332 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4333 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4334 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4335 for details.
4336
4337 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4338 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4339 the pattern:
4340 @example
4341 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4342 @end example
4343
4344 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4345 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4346 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4347 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4348 @example
4349 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4350 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4351 @end example
4352
4353 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4354 @example
4355 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4356 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4357 @end example
4358
4359 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4360 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4361
4362 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4363 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4364 example with a proper dap name:
4365 @example
4366 xxx.dap apcsw default
4367 @end example
4368 @end deffn
4369
4370 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4371 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4372 Disabled by default
4373 @end deffn
4374
4375
4376 @node CPU Configuration
4377 @chapter CPU Configuration
4378 @cindex GDB target
4379
4380 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4381 You can also access these targets without GDB
4382 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4383 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4384 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4385 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4386
4387 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4388 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4389
4390 @section Target List
4391 @cindex target, current
4392 @cindex target, list
4393
4394 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4395 where each member has a name.
4396 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4397 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4398 (plural!) command.
4399 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4400 look like with more than one:
4401 @verbatim
4402 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4403 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4404 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4405 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4406 @end verbatim
4407
4408 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4409 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4410 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4411 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4412 space seen by that current target.
4413 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4414 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4415 are examples; and there are many more.
4416
4417 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4418
4419 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4420 Returns the name of the current target.
4421 @end deffn
4422
4423 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4424 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4425 @example
4426 foreach t [target names] @{
4427 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4428 @}
4429 @end example
4430 @end deffn
4431
4432 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4433 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4434
4435 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4436 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4437 command names are singular.}
4438
4439 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4440 targets in a user friendly form.
4441
4442 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4443 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4444 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4445 @end deffn
4446
4447 @section Target CPU Types
4448 @cindex target type
4449 @cindex CPU type
4450
4451 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4452 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4453 when calling @command{target create}.
4454 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4455 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4456 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4457 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4458 what core-specific commands may be available
4459 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4460 and more.
4461
4462 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4463 since there's a command to list them.
4464
4465 @anchor{targettypes}
4466 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4467 Lists all supported target types.
4468 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4472 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4473 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4474 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4475 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4476 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4477 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4478 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4479 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4480 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4481 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4482 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4483 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4484 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4485 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4486 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4487 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4488 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4489 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4490 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4491 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4492 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4493 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4494 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4495 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4496 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4497 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4498 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4499 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4500 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4501 support for new CPUs.
4502 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4503 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4504 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4505 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4506 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4507 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4508 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4509 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4510 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4511 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4512 @itemize @minus
4513 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4514 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4515 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4516 @end itemize
4517 And two debug interfaces cores:
4518 @itemize @minus
4519 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4520 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4521 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4522 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4523 @end itemize
4524 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4525 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4526 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4527 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4528 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4529 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4530 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4531 @end itemize
4532 @end deffn
4533
4534 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4535 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4536 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4537 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4538 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4539 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4540 reflect design generations;
4541 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4542 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4543
4544 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4545 @section Target Configuration
4546
4547 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4548 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4549 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4550 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4551 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4552
4553 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4554 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4555 optional parts.
4556 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4557 command, created as part of target creation.
4558
4559 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4560 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4561 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4562 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4563 to be much more board-specific.
4564 The key steps you use might look something like this
4565
4566 @example
4567 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4568 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4569 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4570 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4571 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4572 @end example
4573
4574 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4575 on-chip SRAM.
4576 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4577 writes to target memory;
4578 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4579 GDB memory checksumming;
4580 and more.
4581
4582 @quotation Warning
4583 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4584 inaccessible when application code
4585 (such as an operating system)
4586 enables or disables the MMU.
4587 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4588 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4589 easy access to other addresses needed.
4590 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4591 @end quotation
4592
4593 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4594 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4595 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4596 controllers.
4597 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4598 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4599 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4600
4601 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4602 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4603 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4604 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4605 purposes including additional configuration.
4606
4607 @itemize @bullet
4608 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4609 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4610 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4611 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4612
4613 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4614 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4615 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4616 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4617 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4618 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4619 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4620
4621 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4622 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4623 @end itemize
4624 @end deffn
4625
4626 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4627 The options accepted by this command may also be
4628 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4629 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4630 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4631
4632 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4633 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4634 and changing its endianness.
4635
4636 @itemize @bullet
4637
4638 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4639 used to access this target.
4640
4641 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4642 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4643 create and manage DAP instances.
4644
4645 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4646 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4647
4648 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4649 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4650 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4651 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4652 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4653 same event name assigns only one handler.
4654
4655 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4656 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4657
4658 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4659 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4660 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4661 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4662 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4663 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4664 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4665
4666 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4667 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4668 or virtual address is being used.
4669
4670 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4671 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4672
4673 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4674 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4675 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4676 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4677 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4678
4679 @anchor{rtostype}
4680 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4681 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4682 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4683 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4684 @option{RIOT}
4685 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4686
4687 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4688 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4689 access the target for debugging.
4690
4691 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4692 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4693 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4694 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4695
4696 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4697 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4698 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4699 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4700 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4701
4702 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4703 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4704 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4705 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4706 command @command{gdb_port}.
4707 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4708
4709 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4710 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4711 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4712 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4713 @end itemize
4714 @end deffn
4715
4716 @section Other $target_name Commands
4717 @cindex object command
4718
4719 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4720 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4721
4722 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4723 Once a button is created a button
4724 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4725 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4726 configure it like this:
4727
4728 @example
4729 # Create
4730 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4731 # Modify
4732 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4733 # Query
4734 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4735 # Report
4736 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4737 @end example
4738
4739 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4740 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4741
4742 @example
4743 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4744 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4745 @end example
4746
4747 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4748
4749 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4750 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4751 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4752 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4753 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4754 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4755 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4756 They are not otherwise documented here.
4757 @end deffn
4758
4759 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4760 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4761 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4762 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4763 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4764 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4765 the target side uses raw memory.
4766
4767 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4768 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4769 The script orientation comes from working with data
4770 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4771 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4772 and neither store nor return those values.
4773
4774 @itemize
4775 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4776 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4777 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4778 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4779 @end itemize
4780 @end deffn
4781
4782 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4783 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4784 @command{$target_name configure}
4785 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4786 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4787 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4788 There are a few special cases:
4789
4790 @itemize @bullet
4791 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4792 event named @var{event_name}.
4793 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4794 two parameters.
4795 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4796 This is a special case because this is set using
4797 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4798 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4799 @end itemize
4800
4801 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4802 all the targets you might use something like this:
4803
4804 @example
4805 foreach name [target names] @{
4806 set y [$name cget -endian]
4807 set z [$name cget -type]
4808 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4809 $x $name $y $z]
4810 @}
4811 @end example
4812 @end deffn
4813
4814 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4815 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4816 Displays the current target state:
4817 @code{debug-running},
4818 @code{halted},
4819 @code{reset},
4820 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4821 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4822 @end deffn
4823
4824 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4825 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4826 currently associated with this target.
4827 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4828 @end deffn
4829
4830 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4831 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4832 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4833 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4834 @end deffn
4835
4836 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4837 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4838 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4839 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4840 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4841 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4842 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4843 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4844 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4845 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4846 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4847 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4848 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4849 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4850 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4851 @end deffn
4852
4853 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4854 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4855 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4856 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4857 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4858 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4859 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4860 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4861 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4862 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4863 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4864 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4865 @end deffn
4866
4867 @anchor{targetevents}
4868 @section Target Events
4869 @cindex target events
4870 @cindex events
4871 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4872 For example:
4873 @itemize @bullet
4874 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4875 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4876 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4877 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4878 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4879 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4880 to set up system clocks or
4881 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4882 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4883 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4884 @end itemize
4885
4886 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4887 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4888 @command{target create ... -event}.
4889
4890 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4891 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4892 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4893
4894 @example
4895 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4896 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4897 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4898 @}
4899 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4900 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4901 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4902 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4903 @}
4904 @end example
4905
4906 The following target events are defined:
4907
4908 @itemize @bullet
4909 @item @b{debug-halted}
4910 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4911 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4912 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4913 @item @b{early-halted}
4914 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4915 @item @b{examine-start}
4916 @* Before target examine is called.
4917 @item @b{examine-end}
4918 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4919 @item @b{examine-fail}
4920 @* After target examine fails.
4921 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4922 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4923 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4924 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4925 connect GDB to running target.
4926 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4927 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4928 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4929 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4930 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4931 is in RAM or read only memory.
4932 Default is @code{halt}
4933 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4934 @* When GDB disconnects
4935 @item @b{gdb-end}
4936 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4937 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4938 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4939 @code{reset init})
4940 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4941 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4942 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4943 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4944 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4945 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4946 @item @b{gdb-start}
4947 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4948 @item @b{halted}
4949 @* The target has halted
4950 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4951 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4952 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4953 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4954 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4955 @item @b{reset-assert}
4956 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4957 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4958 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4959 it instead of asserting SRST.
4960 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4961 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4962 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4963 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4964 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4965 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4966 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4967 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4968 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4969 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4970 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4971 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4972 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4973 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4974 released on the scan chain.
4975 @item @b{reset-end}
4976 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4977 @item @b{reset-init}
4978 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4979 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4980
4981 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4982 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4983 multiplexing, and so on.
4984 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4985 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4986 @item @b{reset-start}
4987 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4988 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4989
4990 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4991 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4992 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4993 @item @b{resume-start}
4994 @* Before any target is resumed
4995 @item @b{resume-end}
4996 @* After all targets have resumed
4997 @item @b{resumed}
4998 @* Target has resumed
4999 @item @b{step-start}
5000 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5001 @item @b{step-end}
5002 @* After single-step has completed
5003 @item @b{trace-config}
5004 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5005 @end itemize
5006
5007 @quotation Note
5008 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5009 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5010 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5011 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5012 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5013 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5014 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5015 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5016 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5017 check if the core has changed status.
5018 @end quotation
5019
5020 @node Flash Commands
5021 @chapter Flash Commands
5022
5023 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5024 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5025 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5026 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5027 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5028 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5029 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5030 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5031 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5032
5033 Flash Steps:
5034 @enumerate
5035 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5036 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5037 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5038 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5039 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5040 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5041 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5042 @item GDB Flashing
5043 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5044 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5045 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5046 @end enumerate
5047
5048 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5049 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5050 so that it can't boot.
5051 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5052 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5053
5054 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5055 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5056 @cindex flash configuration
5057
5058 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5059 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5060 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5061 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5062 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5063 see the driver-specific documentation.
5064
5065 @itemize @bullet
5066 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5067 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5068 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5069 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5070 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5071 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5072 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5073 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5074 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5075 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5076 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5077 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5078 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5079 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5080 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5081 commands to the flash controller.
5082 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5083 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5084 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5085 for more information.
5086 @end itemize
5087 @quotation Note
5088 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5089 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5090 @end quotation
5091 @end deffn
5092
5093 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5094 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5095 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5096 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5097 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5098 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5099 @end deffn
5100
5101 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5102 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5103 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5104 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5105 @end deffn
5106
5107 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5108 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5109 depends on the flash type.
5110 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5111 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5112 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5113 but most don't bother.
5114 @end deffn
5115
5116 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5117
5118 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5119 begins.
5120
5121 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5122 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5123 until the programming session is finished.
5124
5125 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5126 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5127
5128 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5129
5130 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5131 @cindex flash erasing
5132 @cindex flash reading
5133 @cindex flash writing
5134 @cindex flash programming
5135 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5136
5137 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5138 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5139 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5140 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5141 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5142
5143 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5144 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5145 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5146 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5147 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5148
5149 @quotation Note
5150 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5151 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5152 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5153 back to a flash bank.
5154 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5155 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5156 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5157 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5158 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5159 @end quotation
5160
5161 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5162 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5163 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5164 disabled first.
5165 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5166 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5167 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5168
5169 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5170 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5171 up to and including @var{last}.
5172 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5173 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5174 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5175 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5176 @end deffn
5177
5178 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5179 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5180 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5181 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5182 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5183 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5184 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5185 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5186 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5187 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5188 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5189 before erase starts.
5190 @end deffn
5191
5192 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5193 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5194 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5195 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5196 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5197 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5198 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5199 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5200 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5201 before issuing this command.
5202 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5203 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5204 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5205 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5206 @end deffn
5207 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5208
5209 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5210 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5211 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5212 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5213 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5214 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5215 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5216 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5217 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5218 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5219 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5223 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5224 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5225 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5230 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5231 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5232 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5233 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5238 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5239 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5240 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5241 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5245 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5246 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5247 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5248 to the base address for each section in the image.
5249 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5250 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5251 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5252 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5253 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5254 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5255 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5256 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5257 each image section.
5258
5259 @quotation Warning
5260 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5261 data you want to preserve.
5262 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5263 sections might be erased with no notice.
5264 @itemize
5265 @item
5266 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5267 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5268 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5269 @item
5270 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5271 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5272 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5273 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5274 @end itemize
5275 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5276 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5277 @end quotation
5278
5279 @end deffn
5280
5281 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5282 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5283 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5284 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5285 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5286 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5287 ordinary memory reads.
5288 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5289 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5290 check for successful programming.
5291 @end deffn
5292
5293 @section Other Flash commands
5294 @cindex flash protection
5295
5296 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5297 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5298 and display that status.
5299 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5300 @end deffn
5301
5302 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5303 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5304 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5305
5306 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5307 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5308 and possibly stale information.
5309 @end deffn
5310
5311 @anchor{flashprotect}
5312 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5313 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5314 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5315 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5316 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5317 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5318 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5319 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5320 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5321 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5322 @end deffn
5323
5324 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5325 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5326 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5327 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5328 @end deffn
5329
5330 @anchor{program}
5331 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5332 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5333 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5334 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5335 @end deffn
5336
5337 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5338 @section Flash Driver List
5339 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5340 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5341 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5342
5343 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5344 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5345 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5346
5347 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5348
5349 @itemize
5350 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5351 @end itemize
5352
5353 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5354 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5355 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5356 @example
5357 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5358 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5359 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5360 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5361 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5362 @end example
5363 @end deffn
5364
5365 @subsection External Flash
5366
5367 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5368 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5369 @cindex CFI
5370 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5371 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5372 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5373 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5374 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5375 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5376 configure a bus and its timings), or
5377 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5378 on the flash chip.
5379 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5380 speed up operation.
5381
5382 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5383
5384 @itemize
5385 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5386 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5387 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5388 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5389 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5390 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5391 @end itemize
5392
5393 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5394 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5395
5396 @example
5397 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5398 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5399 @end example
5400
5401 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5402 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5403 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5404
5405 @example
5406 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5407 @end example
5408
5409 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5410 @end deffn
5411
5412 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5413 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5414 @cindex SPI
5415 @cindex jtagspi
5416 @cindex bscan_spi
5417 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5418 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5419 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5420 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5421 accessed through JTAG.
5422
5423 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5424 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5425 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5426 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5427 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5428 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5429
5430 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5431 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5432 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5433 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5434 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5435 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5436 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5437 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5438
5439 @itemize
5440 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5441 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5442 @var{USER1} instruction.
5443 @end itemize
5444
5445 @example
5446 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5447 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5449 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5450 @end example
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5454 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5455 @cindex xcf
5456 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5457 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5458 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5459 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5460 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5461
5462 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5463 command accepts additional parameters:
5464 @itemize
5465 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5466 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5467 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5468 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5469 in master mode.
5470 @end itemize
5471 @example
5472 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5473 @end example
5474 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5475 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5476 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5477 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5478 dedicated sector.
5479 @end deffn
5480
5481 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5482 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5483 button.
5484 @example
5485 xcf configure 0
5486 @end example
5487 @end deffn
5488
5489 Additional driver notes:
5490 @itemize
5491 @item Only single revision supported.
5492 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5493 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5494 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5495 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5496 @end itemize
5497 @end deffn
5498
5499 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5500 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5501 @cindex SPIFI
5502 @cindex lpcspifi
5503 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5504 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5505 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5506
5507 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5508 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5509 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5510 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5511 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5512
5513 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5514 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5515 are configured by the driver.
5516
5517 @example
5518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5519 @end example
5520
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5524 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5525 @cindex SMI
5526 @cindex stmsmi
5527 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5528 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5529 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5530 SPI flash devices.
5531 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5532 flash devices can be connected.
5533
5534 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5535 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5536 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5537 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5538 the flash content.
5539
5540 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5541 to identify the memory bank.
5542 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5543 flash size, are detected automatically.
5544
5545 @example
5546 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5547 @end example
5548
5549 @end deffn
5550
5551 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5552 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5553 @cindex QuadSPI
5554 @cindex OctoSPI
5555 @cindex stmqspi
5556 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5557 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5558 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5559 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5560 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5561 mode is not.
5562
5563 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5564 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5565 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5566 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5567
5568 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5569 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5570 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5571
5572 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5573 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5574 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5575 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5576 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5577 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5578
5579 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5580 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5581 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5582 should be avoided.
5583
5584 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5585 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5586 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5587 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5588 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5589 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5590
5591 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5592 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5593 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5594 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5595 persist across openocd invocations.
5596
5597 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5598 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5599 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5600 required (see 'set' command).
5601
5602 @example
5603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5604 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5605 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5606 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5607 @end example
5608
5609 There are three specific commands
5610 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5611 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5612 chip specific write protection engaged.
5613 @end deffn
5614
5615 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5616 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5617 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5618 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5619 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5620 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5621
5622 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5623 which don't support an id command.
5624
5625 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5626 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5630 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5631 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5632 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5633 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5634
5635 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5636 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5637 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5638 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5639
5640 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5641
5642 To check basic communication settings, issue
5643 @example
5644 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5645 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5646 @end example
5647 for single flash mode or
5648 @example
5649 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5650 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5651 @end example
5652 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5653
5654 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5655 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5656 need a dummy address, e.g.
5657 @example
5658 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5659 @end example
5660 should return the status register contents.
5661
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5667 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5668 Microcontroller platform.
5669
5670 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5671 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5672
5673 @example
5674 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5675 @end example
5676
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5680 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5681 @cindex ath79
5682 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5683 chip selects.
5684 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5685 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5686 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5687 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5688 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5689 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5690
5691 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5692 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5693 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5694 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5695 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5696 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5697 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5698 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5699 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5700 with the default CS0.
5701 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5702 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5703 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5704
5705 @example
5706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5707
5708 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5709 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5710 # distinguish the banks.
5711 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5712 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5713 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5714 @end example
5715
5716 @end deffn
5717
5718 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5719 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5720 @cindex fespi
5721
5722 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5723
5724 @example
5725 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5726 @end example
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5730
5731 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5732 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5733 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5734 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5735 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5736 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5737
5738 @example
5739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5740 @end example
5741 @end deffn
5742
5743 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5744 @cindex ambiqmicro
5745 @cindex apollo
5746 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5747 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5748 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5749 with the target using SWD.
5750
5751 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5752 the device class of the MCU.
5753 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5754 to set up the flash banks.
5755 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5756 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5757
5758 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5759 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5760 and the second bank starts after the first.
5761
5762 @example
5763 # Flash bank 0
5764 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5765 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5766 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5767 $_TARGETNAME
5768 @end example
5769
5770 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5771 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5772 are available to the user.
5773
5774 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5775
5776 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5777 Erase entire bank.
5778 @end deffn
5779 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5780 Erase device pages.
5781 @end deffn
5782 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5783 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5784 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5785 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5786 the flash.
5787 @end deffn
5788 @end deffn
5789
5790 @anchor{at91samd}
5791 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5792 @cindex at91samd
5793 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5794 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5795
5796 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5797
5798 The devices have one flash bank:
5799
5800 @example
5801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5802 @end example
5803
5804 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5805 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5806 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5807 processor to be halted.
5808 @end deffn
5809
5810 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5811 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5812 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5813 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5814 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5815 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5816
5817 @example
5818 at91samd set-security enable
5819 @end example
5820 @end deffn
5821
5822 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5823 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5824 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5825 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5826 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5827 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5828 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5829 in order to disable this feature.
5830
5831 @example
5832 at91samd eeprom
5833 at91samd eeprom 1024
5834 @end example
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5838 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5839 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5840 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5841 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5842 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5843
5844 @example
5845 at91samd bootloader
5846 at91samd bootloader 16384
5847 @end example
5848 @end deffn
5849
5850 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5851 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5852 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5853 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5854 @end deffn
5855
5856 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5857 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5858 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5859 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5860 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5861 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5862 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5863 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5864
5865 @example
5866 # Read user row
5867 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5868 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5869 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5870 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5871 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5872 # byte unchanged
5873 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5874 @end example
5875 @end deffn
5876
5877 @end deffn
5878
5879 @anchor{at91sam3}
5880 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
5881 @cindex at91sam3
5882 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5883 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5884 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5885 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5886 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5887 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5888 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5889 chips are confirmed.}
5890
5891 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5892 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5893 the following fixed locations:
5894
5895 @example
5896 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5897 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5898 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5899 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5900 @end example
5901
5902 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5903 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5904 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5905
5906 @itemize
5907 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5908 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5909 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5910 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5911 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5912 @end itemize
5913
5914 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5915
5916 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5917 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5918 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5919 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5920 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5921 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5922 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5923
5924 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5925 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
5929 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5930 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5931 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5932 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5933 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5934 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5935 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5936 @end deffn
5937
5938 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5939 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5940 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5941 @end deffn
5942 @end deffn
5943
5944 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
5945 @cindex at91sam4
5946 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5947 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5948 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
5952 @cindex at91sam4l
5953 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5954 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5955 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5956
5957 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5958 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5959 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5960 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5961 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5962 @end deffn
5963 @end deffn
5964
5965 @anchor{atsame5}
5966 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
5967 @cindex atsame5
5968 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5969 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5970 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5971
5972 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5973 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5974 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5975
5976 @example
5977 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5978 @end example
5979
5980 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
5981 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5982 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5983 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5984 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5985 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5986
5987 @example
5988 atsame5 bootloader
5989 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5990 @end example
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
5994 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5995 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5996 processor to be halted.
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6000 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6001 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6002 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6006 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6007 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6008 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6009 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6010 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6011 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6012 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6013
6014 @example
6015 # Read
6016 >atsame5 userpage
6017 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6018 # Write
6019 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6020 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6021 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6022 # bytes)
6023 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6024 @end example
6025 @end deffn
6026
6027 @end deffn
6028
6029 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6030 @cindex atsamv
6031 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6032 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6033 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6037 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6038 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6039 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6040 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6041
6042 @example
6043 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6044 @end example
6045
6046 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6047 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6048
6049 @itemize
6050 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6051 @item @var{banks}
6052 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6053 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6054 @item @var{pages_size}
6055 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6056 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6057 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6058 @end itemize
6059
6060 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6061 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6062 will be autoconfigured.
6063 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6064
6065 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6066 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6067 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6068 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6069 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6070
6071 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6072 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6073 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6074 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6075 are not truly general purpose).
6076 @quotation Note
6077 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6078 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6079 @end quotation
6080 @end deffn
6081 @end deffn
6082
6083 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6084 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6085 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6086 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6090 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6091 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6092 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6093
6094 @example
6095 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6096 @end example
6097
6098 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6099 each single sector one by one.
6100
6101 @example
6102 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6103 @end example
6104
6105 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6109 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6110 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6111 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6112 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6113 starts at address 0.
6114
6115 @example
6116 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6117 @end example
6118 @end deffn
6119
6120 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6121 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6122 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6123 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6124 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6125 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6126 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6127 and programming the serial flash.
6128
6129 @example
6130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6131 @end example
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6135 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6136 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6137 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6138 autoconfigures itself.
6139 @example
6140 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6141 @end example
6142 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6143 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6144 this via the following command:
6145 @example
6146 efm32 debuglock num
6147 @end example
6148 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6149 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6150 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6151 supported.}
6152 @end deffn
6153
6154 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6155 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6156 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6157 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6158 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6159 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6160
6161 @example
6162 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6163 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6164 @end example
6165
6166 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6167 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6171 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6172 is an uncommon operation.}
6173 @end deffn
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6177 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6178 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6179 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6180 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6181 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6182 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6183
6184 @example
6185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6186 @end example
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6190 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6191 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6192 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6193 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6194 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6195 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6196 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6197 characters) ignored.
6198
6199 @example
6200 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6201 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6202 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6203 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6204 @end example
6205 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6206 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6207 @end deffn
6208
6209 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6210 @cindex kinetis
6211 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6212 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6213 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6214 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6215 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6216 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6217
6218 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6219 @itemize
6220 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6221 @end itemize
6222
6223 @example
6224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6225 @end example
6226
6227 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6228 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6229 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6230 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6234 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6235 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6236 set by 'flash protect' command.
6237 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6238 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6239 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6240 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6241 with the rest of a flash image.
6242 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6243 @end deffn
6244
6245 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6246 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6247 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6251 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6252 and examine-fail event.
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6256 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6257 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6261 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6262 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6263 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6264 command completes.
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6268 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6269 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6270 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6271 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6272
6273 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6274 Program Partition command.
6275
6276 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6277 Reset the device after partition setting.
6278
6279 Show partition size:
6280 @example
6281 kinetis nvm_partition info
6282 @end example
6283
6284 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6285 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6286 @example
6287 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6288 @end example
6289
6290 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6291 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6292 @example
6293 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6294 @end example
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6298 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6299 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6300 @end deffn
6301
6302 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6303 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6304 Command disables watchdog timer.
6305 @end deffn
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6309 @cindex kinetis_ke
6310 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6311 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6312 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6313 autoconfigures itself.
6314 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6315
6316 @example
6317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6318 @end example
6319
6320 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6321 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6325 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6326 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6327 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6328 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6332 Command disables watchdog timer.
6333 @end deffn
6334 @end deffn
6335
6336 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6337 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6338 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6339 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6340 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6341
6342 @quotation Note
6343 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6344 driver:
6345 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6346 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6347 @end quotation
6348
6349 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6350 which must appear in the following order:
6351
6352 @itemize
6353 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6354 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6355 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6356 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6357 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6358 LPC43x[2357])
6359 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6360 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6361 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6362 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6363 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6364 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6365 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6366 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6367 at which the core is running
6368 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6369 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6370 @quotation Note
6371 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6372 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6373 However, if you do provide it,
6374 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6375 @end quotation
6376 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6377 ROM IAP entry point.
6378 @end itemize
6379
6380 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6381
6382 @example
6383 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6384 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6385 @end example
6386
6387 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6388 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6389 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6390 @end deffn
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6394 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6395 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6396 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6397 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6398 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6399
6400 @example
6401 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6402 @end example
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6406 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6407 from NXP.
6408
6409 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6410 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6411 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6412 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6413 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6414 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6415 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6416 you start the PLL.
6417
6418 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6419
6420 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6421 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6422 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6423
6424 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6425 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6426 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6427 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6428 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6429 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6430 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6431
6432 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6433 @example
6434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6435 @end example
6436
6437 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6438 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6439 @code{flash banks} command.
6440
6441 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6442 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6443 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6444 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6445 a known signature.
6446 Example:
6447 @example
6448 lpc2900 signature 0
6449 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6450 @end example
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6454 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6455 saves it to a file in binary format.
6456 Example:
6457 @example
6458 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6459 @end example
6460 @end deffn
6461
6462 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6463 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6464 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6465 command:
6466
6467 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6468 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6469 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6470 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6471
6472 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6473 Example:
6474 @example
6475 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6476 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6477 @end example
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6481 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6482 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6483 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6484 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6485 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6486 912 bytes.
6487 @quotation Attention
6488 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6489 @end quotation
6490 Example:
6491 @example
6492 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6493 @end example
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6497 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6498 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6499 after the next power cycle.
6500 @quotation Attention
6501 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6502 @end quotation
6503 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6504 Example:
6505 @example
6506 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6507 flash info 0
6508 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6509 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6510 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6511 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6512 @end example
6513 @end deffn
6514
6515 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6516 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6517 effective after the next power cycle.
6518 @quotation Attention
6519 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6520 @end quotation
6521 Examples:
6522 @example
6523 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6524 @end example
6525 @end deffn
6526 @end deffn
6527
6528 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6529 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6530 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6531 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6532
6533 @example
6534 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6535 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6536 @end example
6537
6538 @itemize @bullet
6539 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6540 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6541 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6542 @end itemize
6543
6544 Example usage:
6545 @example
6546 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6547 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6548 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6549 @} else @{
6550 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6551 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6552 @}
6553 @end example
6554 @end deffn
6555
6556 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6557 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6558 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6559 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6560 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6561 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6562
6563 @example
6564 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6565 @end example
6566
6567 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6568 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6569 only the main program flash.
6570
6571 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6572 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6573 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6577 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6578 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6579 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6580
6581 To erase and program the BSL:
6582 @example
6583 msp432 bsl unlock
6584 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6585 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6586 msp432 bsl lock
6587 @end example
6588 @end deffn
6589 @end deffn
6590
6591 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6592 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6593 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6594 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6595 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6596 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6597 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6598 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6599 also have division into regions: main and info.
6600 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6601 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6602
6603 @example
6604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6605 @end example
6606
6607 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6608
6609 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6610 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6614 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6615 @end deffn
6616
6617 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6618 Erase all userflash including info region.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6622 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6623 @end deffn
6624
6625 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6626 Check sectors protect.
6627 @end deffn
6628
6629 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6630 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6631 @end deffn
6632
6633 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6634 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6638 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6642 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6643 @end deffn
6644
6645 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6646 Show information about flash driver.
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6652 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6653 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6654 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6655 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6656
6657 @example
6658 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6659 @end example
6660
6661 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6662
6663 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6664 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6665 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6666 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6667 code.
6668 @end deffn
6669
6670 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6671 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6677 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6678 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6679
6680 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6681 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6682 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6683 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6684
6685 @example
6686 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6687 @end example
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6691 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6692 and integrate flash memory.
6693
6694 @example
6695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6697 @end example
6698
6699 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6700 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6701 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6702 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6703 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6704 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6705 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6706 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6707 @end deffn
6708 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6709 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6710 This will remove any Code Protection.
6711 @end deffn
6712 @end deffn
6713
6714 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6715 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6716 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6717 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6718 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6719
6720 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6721 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6722
6723 @example
6724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6725 @end example
6726
6727 psoc4-specific commands
6728 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6729 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6730
6731 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6732 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6733
6734 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6735 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6736 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6737
6738 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6742 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6743
6744 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6745 @end deffn
6746 @end deffn
6747
6748 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6749 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6750 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6751 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6752 apart from the base address.
6753
6754 @example
6755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6756 @end example
6757
6758 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6759 @quotation Attention
6760 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6761 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6762 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6763 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6764 @end quotation
6765
6766 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6767
6768 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6769 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6770 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6771 @end deffn
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6775 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6776 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6777 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6778 apart from the base address.
6779
6780 @example
6781 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6782 $_TARGETNAME
6783 @end example
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6787 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6788 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6789 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6790
6791 @example
6792 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6793 @end example
6794
6795 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6796
6797 @itemize
6798 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6799 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6800 @end itemize
6801
6802 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6803
6804 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6805 @quotation Attention
6806 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6807 after successful write.
6808 @end quotation
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6812 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6813 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6814 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6815
6816 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6817 @itemize @bullet
6818 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6819 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6820 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6821 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6822 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6823 row size: 512 bytes.
6824 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6825 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6826 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6827 operation will erase row automatically.
6828 @end itemize
6829
6830 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6831 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6832
6833 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6834
6835 @example
6836 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6837 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6838 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6839 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6840 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6841 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6842 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6843 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6844 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6845 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6846 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6847 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6848
6849 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6850 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6851 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6852 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6853 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6854 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6855 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6856 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6857 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6858 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6859 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6860 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6861 @end example
6862
6863 psoc6-specific commands
6864 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
6865 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6866 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6867 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6868 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6869 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6870 @end deffn
6871
6872 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6873 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6874 by @command{flash banks}.
6875 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6876 @end deffn
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
6880 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6881 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6882 and SWD interface.
6883 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6884 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6885
6886 @example
6887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6888 @end example
6889
6890 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6891
6892 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
6893 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6894 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6895 @end deffn
6896
6897 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
6898 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6899 @end deffn
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
6903 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6904 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6905 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6906 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6907
6908 @example
6909 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6910 @end example
6911
6912 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
6913 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6914 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6915 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6916 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6917 disabled.
6918
6919 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6920 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6921 @quotation Warning
6922 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6923 applied to all of them.
6924 @end quotation
6925 @end deffn
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
6929 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6930 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0 and GD32F3x0 microcontroller
6931 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6932 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6933 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6934
6935 @example
6936 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6937 @end example
6938
6939 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6940 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6941 the flash driver.
6942
6943 @example
6944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6945 @end example
6946
6947 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6948 as per the following example.
6949 @example
6950 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6951 @end example
6952
6953 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6954
6955 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
6956 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6957 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6958 @end deffn
6959
6960 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
6961 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6962 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6963 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6964 @end deffn
6965
6966 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6967 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6968 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6969 @end deffn
6970
6971 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
6972 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6973 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6974 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6978 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6979 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6980 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6981 @end deffn
6982
6983 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
6984 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6985 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6986 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6987 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6988 @end deffn
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
6992 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6993 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6994 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6995 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6996
6997 @example
6998 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6999 @end example
7000
7001 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7002 as per the following example.
7003 @example
7004 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7005 @end example
7006
7007 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7008 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7009 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7010 @end deffn
7011
7012 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7013 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7014 the flash driver.
7015
7016 @example
7017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7018 @end example
7019
7020 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7021
7022 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7023 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7024 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7028 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7029 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7033 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7034 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7038 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7039 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7040 @end deffn
7041
7042 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7043 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7044 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7045 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7046 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7047 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7051 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7052 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7053 @end deffn
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7057 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7058 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7059 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7060 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7061
7062 @example
7063 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7064 @end example
7065
7066 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7067 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7068 the flash driver.
7069
7070 @example
7071 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7072 @end example
7073
7074 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7075
7076 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7077 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7078 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7082 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7083 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7084 @end deffn
7085
7086 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7087 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7088 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7089 @end deffn
7090
7091 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7092 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7093 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7094 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7095 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7096
7097 Example usage:
7098 @example
7099 # read OPTSR_CUR
7100 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7101 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7102 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7103 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7104 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7105 @end example
7106 @end deffn
7107
7108 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7109 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7110 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7111 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7112 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7113 will be touched).
7114
7115 Example usage:
7116 @example
7117 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7118 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7119 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7120 @end example
7121 @end deffn
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7125 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7126 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7127 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7128 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7129
7130 @example
7131 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7132 @end example
7133
7134 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7135 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7136 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7137 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7138 second bank.
7139
7140 @example
7141 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7142 @end example
7143
7144 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7145
7146 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7147 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7148 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7152 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7153 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7154 @end deffn
7155
7156 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7157 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7158 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7159 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7161 @end deffn
7162 @end deffn
7163
7164 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7165 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7166 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7167 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7168 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7169 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7170
7171 @example
7172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7173 @end example
7174
7175 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7176 as per the following example.
7177 @example
7178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7179 @end example
7180
7181 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7182 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7187 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7188 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7189 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7190
7191 @example
7192 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7193 @end example
7194
7195 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7196
7197 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7198 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7199 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7200 @end deffn
7201
7202 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7203 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7204 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7205 @end deffn
7206
7207 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7208 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7213 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7214 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7215 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7216
7217 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7218 @example
7219 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7220 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7221 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7222 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7223 @end example
7224
7225 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7226 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7230 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7232 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7233 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7234
7235 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7236 @example
7237 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7238 @end example
7239
7240 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7241 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7242 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7246 List the protected areas using WRP.
7247 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7248 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7249 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7250
7251 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7252 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7253 in single or dual-banks mode.
7254 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7255 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7256
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7260 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7261 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7262 @end deffn
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7266 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7267 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7268 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7269 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7270
7271 @example
7272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7273 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7274 @end example
7275
7276 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7277 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7278 for the specified flash bank.
7279 @end deffn
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7283 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7284 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7285 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7286 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7287
7288 @example
7289 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7290 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7291 @end example
7292
7293 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7294 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7295 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7296
7297 @itemize @bullet
7298 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7299 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7300 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7301 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7302 @end itemize
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @end deffn
7306
7307 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7308 @cindex str9xpec
7309
7310 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7311 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7312 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7313 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7314
7315 Here is some background info to help
7316 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7317 the str9:
7318 @enumerate
7319 @item
7320 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7321 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7322 @item
7323 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7324 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7325 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7326 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7327 @end enumerate
7328
7329 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7330 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7331 configured for flash bank 0.
7332 @example
7333 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7334 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7335 adapter assert srst
7336 # turn off target polling
7337 poll off
7338 # disable str9 core
7339 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7340 # read option bytes
7341 str9xpec options_read 0
7342 # re-enable str9 core
7343 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7344 poll on
7345 reset halt
7346 @end example
7347 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7348 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7349 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7350 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7351
7352 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7353
7354 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7355 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7359 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7360 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7364 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7365 erase the device.
7366 @end deffn
7367
7368 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7369 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7373 Configure str9 boot bank.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7377 Configure str9 lvd source.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7381 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7385 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7389 Read str9 option bytes.
7390 @end deffn
7391
7392 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7393 Write str9 option bytes.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7397 unlock str9 device.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7403 @cindex swm050
7404 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7405
7406 @example
7407 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7408 @end example
7409
7410 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7411
7412 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7413 Erases the entire flash bank.
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418
7419 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7420 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7421 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7422 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7423
7424 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7425
7426 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7427 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7431 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7432 @end deffn
7433
7434 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7435 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7436 the flash clock.
7437 @end deffn
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7441 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7442 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7443 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7444 correct bank config.
7445
7446 @example
7447 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7448 @end example
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7452 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7453 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7457 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7458 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7459
7460 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7461
7462 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7463 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7464 @end deffn
7465
7466 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7467 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7468 @end deffn
7469
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @section NAND Flash Commands
7473 @cindex NAND
7474
7475 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7476 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7477 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7478
7479 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7480 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7481 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7482 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7483 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7484 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7485
7486 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7487 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7488 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7489 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7490 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7491 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7492 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7493 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7494 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7495 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7496
7497 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7498 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7499 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7500 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7501 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7502 every 512 bytes of data.
7503
7504 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7505 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7506 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7507 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7508 ECC mode is used.
7509
7510 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7511 @enumerate
7512 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7513 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7514 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7515 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7516 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7517 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7518 to access that device.
7519 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7520 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7521 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7522 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7523 de-brick a board.
7524 @end enumerate
7525
7526 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7527 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7528 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7529 are only 32 bits wide.
7530 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7531 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7532 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7533 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7534
7535 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7536 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7537 @cindex NAND configuration
7538
7539 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7540 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7541 OpenOCD has initialized.
7542
7543 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7544 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7545 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7546 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7547 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7548 they were a single (larger) device.
7549 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7550 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7551
7552 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7553 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7554 configuration files, not interactively.
7555
7556 @itemize @bullet
7557 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7558 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7559 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7560 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7561 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7562 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7563 commands to the NAND controller.
7564 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7565 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7566 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7567 for more information.
7568 @end itemize
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7572 Prints a summary of each device declared
7573 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7574 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7575 @example
7576 > nand list
7577 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7578 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7579 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7580 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7581 >
7582 @end example
7583 @end deffn
7584
7585 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7586 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7587 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7588 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7589 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7590 it with most other NAND commands.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7594
7595 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7596 @cindex NAND reading
7597 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7598 starting at the specified offset.
7599 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7600
7601 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7602 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7603
7604 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7605 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7606 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7607
7608 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7609 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7610 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7611 method which handled that error correction.
7612
7613 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7614 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7615 @itemize @bullet
7616 @item no oob_* parameter
7617 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7618 @item @code{oob_raw}
7619 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7620 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7621 spare areas associated with each data page.
7622 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7623 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7624 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7625 @item @code{oob_only}
7626 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7627 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7628 spare areas associated with each data page.
7629 @end itemize
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7633 @cindex NAND erasing
7634 @cindex NAND programming
7635 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7636 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7637 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7638 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7639 If those parameters are not specified,
7640 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7641 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7642
7643 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7644 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7645 block marker.
7646 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7647 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7651 @cindex NAND writing
7652 @cindex NAND programming
7653 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7654 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7655 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7656 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7657
7658 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7659 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7660
7661 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7662 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7663 past the end of the device.
7664 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7665 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7666 if that's being written.)
7667
7668 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7669 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7670 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7671
7672 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7673 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7674 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7675 @itemize @bullet
7676 @item no oob_* parameter
7677 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7678 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7679 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7680 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7681 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7682 @item @code{oob_only}
7683 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7684 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7685 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7686 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7687 @item @code{oob_raw}
7688 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7689 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7690 un-altered OOB.
7691 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7692 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7693 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7694 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7695 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7696 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7697 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7698 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7699 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7700 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7701 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7702 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7703 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7704 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7705 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7706 @end itemize
7707 @end deffn
7708
7709 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7710 @cindex NAND verification
7711 @cindex NAND programming
7712 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7713 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7714 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7715
7716 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7717 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7718
7719 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7720 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7721 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7722 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7723 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7724
7725 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7726 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7727 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7728
7729 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7730 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7731 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7732 be removed in a future release.
7733 @end deffn
7734
7735 @subsection Other NAND commands
7736 @cindex NAND other commands
7737
7738 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7739 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7740 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7741 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7742 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7743 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7744 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7745 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7746
7747 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7748 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7749 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7750 @end deffn
7751
7752 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7753 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7754 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7755 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7756 status for each block.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7760 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7761 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7762
7763 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7764 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7765 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7766 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7767 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7768
7769 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7770 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7771 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7772 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7773 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7774 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7775 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7776 @end deffn
7777
7778 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7779 @subsection NAND Driver List
7780 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7781 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7782 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7783
7784 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7785 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7786 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7787 address of the ECC controller.
7788 @example
7789 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7790 @end example
7791 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7792 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7793 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7794 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7795 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7796 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7797 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7798 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7799 @end deffn
7800 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7801 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7802 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7803 @end deffn
7804
7805 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7806 properly configured for input or output.
7807 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7808 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7809 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7810 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7811 @end deffn
7812 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7813 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7814 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7815 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7816 @end deffn
7817 @end deffn
7818
7819 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7820 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7821 chips from Texas Instruments.
7822 It takes three extra parameters:
7823 address of the NAND chip;
7824 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7825 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7826 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7827 @example
7828 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7829 @end example
7830 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7831 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7832 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7833 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7834 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7835 @end deffn
7836
7837 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
7838 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7839 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7840 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7841 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7842 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7843 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7847 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7848 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7849 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7850 @end deffn
7851 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7852
7853 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
7854 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7855 should work for this chip as well.
7856 @end deffn
7857
7858 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
7859 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7860 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7861 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7862 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7863 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7864 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7865 @example
7866 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7867 @end example
7868 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7869 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7870 without parameter query status.
7871 @end deffn
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
7875 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7876 parameter: the address of the controller.
7877 @example
7878 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7879 @end example
7880 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7881 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7882 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7883 change any behavior.
7884 @end deffn
7885
7886 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
7887 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
7888 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
7889 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
7890 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
7891 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7892 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7893 specialized commands.
7894 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7895 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7896 change any behavior.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @node Flash Programming
7900 @chapter Flash Programming
7901
7902 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7903 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7904 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7905
7906 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7907 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7908
7909 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7910 @enumerate
7911 @item 'init' is executed.
7912 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7913 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7914 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7915 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7916 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7917 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7918 @end enumerate
7919
7920 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7921
7922 @example
7923 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7924 # are optional parameters
7925 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7926 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7927
7928 # binary files need the flash address passing
7929 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7930 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7931 @end example
7932
7933 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7934 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7935 @cindex PLD
7936 @cindex FPGA
7937
7938 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7939 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7940 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7941 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7942 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7943 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7944 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7945
7946 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7947
7948 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7949 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7950 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7951
7952 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7953 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7954
7955 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7956 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7957 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7958 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7959 behavior.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7963 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7967 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7968 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7969 @end deffn
7970
7971 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7972
7973 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7974 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7975 that particular type of PLD.
7976
7977 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
7978 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7979 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7980
7981 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7982 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7983 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7984
7985 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7986 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7987 for FPGA @var{num}.
7988 @end deffn
7989 @end deffn
7990
7991 @node General Commands
7992 @chapter General Commands
7993 @cindex commands
7994
7995 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7996 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7997 commands are documented elsewhere.
7998
7999 Intent:
8000 @itemize @bullet
8001 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8002 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8003 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8004 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8005
8006 @item @b{From the human}
8007 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8008 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8009
8010 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8011 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8012 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8013
8014 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8015 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8016 port is 5555.
8017 @end itemize
8018
8019
8020 @section Server Commands
8021
8022 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8023 Exits the current telnet session.
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8027 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8028 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8029 Not every command provides helptext.
8030
8031 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8032 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8033 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8034 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8038 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8039 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8040 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8041 Useful in connection with script files
8042 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8043 @end deffn
8044
8045 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8046 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8047 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8048 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8049
8050 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8051 @example
8052 # redefine shutdown
8053 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8054 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8055 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8056 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8057 original_shutdown
8058 @}
8059 @end example
8060 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8061 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @anchor{debuglevel}
8065 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8066 @cindex message level
8067 Display debug level.
8068 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8069 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8070 Level 0 is error messages only;
8071 level 1 adds warnings;
8072 level 2 adds informational messages;
8073 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8074 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8075 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8076 the command line along with the location of that log
8077 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8078 @xref{Running}.
8079 @end deffn
8080
8081 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8082 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8083 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8084 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8085 @example
8086 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8087 @end example
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8091 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8092 the default log output channel is stderr.
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8096 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8097 @end deffn
8098
8099 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8100 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8101 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8102 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8103 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8107 @section Target State handling
8108 @cindex reset
8109 @cindex halt
8110 @cindex target initialization
8111
8112 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8113 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8114 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8115 a current target which is used to perform the
8116 various operations. The current target may be changed
8117 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8118 target which should become current.
8119
8120 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8121 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8122 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8123 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8124 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8125
8126 @emph{With no arguments}:
8127 list all available registers for the current target,
8128 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8129 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8130 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8131 are flagged as such.
8132
8133 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8134 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8135 bypassing any internal cache.
8136
8137 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8138 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8139 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8140 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8141 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8142 relevant module will flush such values.
8143
8144 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8145 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8146
8147 @example
8148 > reg
8149 ===== ARM registers
8150 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8151 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8152 (2) r2 (/32)
8153 ...
8154 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8155 >
8156 @end example
8157 @end deffn
8158
8159 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8160 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8161 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8162 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8163 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8164 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8165 (and enter debug mode).
8166 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8167
8168 @quotation Warning
8169 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8170 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8171 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8172 power mode by gating the core clock;
8173 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8174
8175 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8176 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8177 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8178 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8179 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8180 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8181
8182 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8183 work with a JTAG debugger.
8184 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8185 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8186 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8187 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8188 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8189 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8190 @end quotation
8191
8192 @end deffn
8193
8194 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8195 Resume the target at its current code position,
8196 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8197 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8198 @end deffn
8199
8200 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8201 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8202 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8203 @end deffn
8204
8205 @anchor{resetcommand}
8206 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8207 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8208 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8209 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8210 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8211 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8212 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8213
8214 The optional parameter specifies what should
8215 happen after the reset.
8216 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8217 The other options will not work on all systems.
8218 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8219
8220 @itemize @minus
8221 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8222 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8223 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8224 @end itemize
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8228 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8229 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8230 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8231 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8232 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8233 state.
8234 @end deffn
8235
8236 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8237 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8238 Set values of reset signals.
8239 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8240 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8241 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8242 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8243
8244 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8245 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8246 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8247 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8248 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8249 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8250 the signal will not be modified.
8251
8252 @quotation Note
8253 TRST is specially handled.
8254 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8255 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8256 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8257 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8258 instead of the TRST signal.
8259 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8260 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8261 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8262 with handlers for that event.
8263 @end quotation
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8267 @section Memory access commands
8268 @cindex memory access
8269
8270 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8271 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8272 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8273 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8274
8275 @enumerate
8276 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8277 to change the current target.
8278 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8279 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8280 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8281 @end enumerate
8282
8283 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8284 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8285 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8286 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8287 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8288 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8289 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8290 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8291 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8292 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8293 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8294 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8295 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8296 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8297 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8298 @end deffn
8299
8300 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8301 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8302 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8303 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8304 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8305 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8306 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8307 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8308 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8309 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8310 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8311 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @anchor{imageaccess}
8315 @section Image loading commands
8316 @cindex image loading
8317 @cindex image dumping
8318
8319 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8320 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8321 binary file named @var{filename}.
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8325 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8326 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8330 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8331 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8332 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8333 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8334 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8335 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8336 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8337 separately.
8338 @end deffn
8339
8340 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8341 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8342 The file format may optionally be specified
8343 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8344 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8345 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8346 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8347 @example
8348 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8349 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8350 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8351 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8352 $address $length
8353 @}
8354 @end example
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8358 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8359 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8360 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8361 The file format may optionally be specified
8362 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8363 @end deffn
8364
8365 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8366 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8367 The file format may optionally be specified
8368 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8369 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8370 @end deffn
8371
8372 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8373 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8374 The file format may optionally be specified
8375 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8376 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379
8380 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8381 @cindex breakpoint
8382 @cindex watchpoint
8383
8384 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8385 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8386 watchpoints.
8387 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8388
8389 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8390 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8391 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8392 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8393 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8394 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8395
8396 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8397 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8398 @end deffn
8399
8400 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8401 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8405 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8409 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8410 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8411 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8412 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8413 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8414 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8415 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8416 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419
8420 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8421
8422 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8423 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8424 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8425 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8426 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8427 running, can be used.
8428 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8429 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8430 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8431
8432 @quotation Note
8433 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8434 @end quotation
8435
8436 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8437 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8438 communication, respectively.
8439
8440 @quotation Note
8441 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8442 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8443 example.
8444 @end quotation
8445
8446 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8447 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8448 of TCP/IP connections.
8449
8450 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8451 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8452 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8453 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8454 @var{size} bytes.
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8458 Start RTT.
8459 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8463 Stop RTT.
8464 @end deffn
8465
8466 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8467 Display the polling interval.
8468 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8469 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8470 checked for new data.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8474 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8475 @end deffn
8476
8477 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8478 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8479 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8480 @end deffn
8481
8482 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8483 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8487 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8491 on the target device.
8492
8493 @example
8494 resume
8495
8496 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8497 rtt start
8498
8499 rtt server start 9090 0
8500 @end example
8501
8502 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8503 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8504 TCP/IP port 9090.
8505
8506
8507 @section Misc Commands
8508
8509 @cindex profiling
8510 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8511 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8512 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8513 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8514 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8515 limit the address range.
8516 @end deffn
8517
8518 @deffn {Command} {version}
8519 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8520 @end deffn
8521
8522 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8523 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8524 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8528 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8529 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8530 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8531
8532 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8533 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8534 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8535 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8536
8537 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8538 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8539 @cindex tracing
8540 @cindex ETM
8541 @cindex ETB
8542
8543 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8544 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8545 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8546
8547 @itemize
8548 @item
8549 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8550 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8551 supports such an interface.
8552 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8553 and trace port support.)
8554 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8555 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8556 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8557 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8558 in the board-specific configuration file.
8559 @item
8560 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8561 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8562 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8563 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8564 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8565 @end itemize
8566
8567 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8568
8569 @quotation Issues
8570 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8571 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8572
8573 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8574 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8575 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8576 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8577 dummy trace port driver}.
8578
8579 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8580 as well as tracing only during specific states
8581 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8582
8583 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8584 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8585 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8586 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8587 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8588
8589 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8590 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8591 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8592 this original style of JTAG access.
8593 @end quotation
8594
8595 @subsection ETM Configuration
8596 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8597
8598 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8599 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8600 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8601
8602 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8603 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8604 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8605 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8606 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8607 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8608 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8609 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8610 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8611
8612 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8613 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8614 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8615
8616 @quotation Warning
8617 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8618 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8619 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8620 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8621 @end quotation
8622
8623 @quotation Note
8624 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8625 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8626 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8627 what CPU activities are traced.
8628 @end quotation
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8632 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8633 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8634 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8635 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8636 @end deffn
8637
8638 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8639 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8640 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8641 Did trace data overflow?
8642 Was it triggered?
8643 @end deffn
8644
8645 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8646 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8647 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8648 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8649 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8650
8651 @itemize
8652 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8653 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8654 The value is one of
8655 @option{none} (save nothing),
8656 @option{data} (save data),
8657 @option{address} (save addresses),
8658 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8659 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8660 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8661 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8662 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8663 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8664 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8665 trace stream without an image of the code.
8666 @end itemize
8667 @end deffn
8668
8669 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8670 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8671 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8672 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8673 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8674
8675 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8676 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8677 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8678 @end deffn
8679
8680 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8681
8682 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8683 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8684 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8685
8686 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8687 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8688 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8689 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8690 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8691 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8692 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8693
8694 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8695
8696 @itemize
8697 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8698 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8699 for instruction access within that function's body.
8700 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8701 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8702 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8703 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8704 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8705 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8706 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8707 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8708 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8709 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8710 @item @emph{... more}
8711 @end itemize
8712
8713 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8714 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8715
8716 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8717 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8718 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8719 @end deffn
8720
8721 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8722 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8723 @end deffn
8724
8725 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8726 Opens an image file.
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8730 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8734 Starts trace data collection.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8738 Stops trace data collection.
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8742 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8743
8744 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8745
8746 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8747 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8748 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8749 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8750 any trace data collection.}
8751 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8752 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8753 @end deffn
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8757 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8758 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8759 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8760 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8761 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8762 @end deffn
8763 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8764 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8765 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8766 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8767 trace trigger becomes active.
8768
8769 @itemize
8770 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8771 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8772 afterwards.
8773 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8774 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8775 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8776 what caused that event to happen.
8777 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8778 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8779 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8780 how the event caused trouble.
8781 @end itemize
8782 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8783 @end deffn
8784
8785 @end deffn
8786
8787 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8788 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8789 @cindex CTI
8790
8791 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8792 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8793 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8794 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8795 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8796 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8797
8798 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8799 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8800 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8801 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8802 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8803 including additional configuration.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8807 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8811 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8815 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8819 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8823 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8824 @end deffn
8825
8826 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8827 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8828 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8832 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8833 of the CTI.
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
8837 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8838 useful in TCL scripting.
8839 @end deffn
8840
8841 @section Generic ARM
8842 @cindex ARM
8843
8844 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8845 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8846 commands that may be available.
8847
8848 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8849 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8850 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8851 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8852 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8853 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8854 @end deffn
8855
8856 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8857 @cindex disassemble
8858 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8859 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8860 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8861 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8862 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8863 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8864 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8865
8866 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8867 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8868 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8869 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8870 with a handful of exceptions.
8871 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8872 @end deffn
8873
8874 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8875 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8876 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8877 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8878 and using the MCR instruction.
8879 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8880 an ARM register.)
8881 @end deffn
8882
8883 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8884 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8885 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8886 and the MRC instruction.
8887 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8888 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8889 an ARM register.)
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
8893 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8894 core mode if necessary.
8895 @end deffn
8896
8897 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8898 @cindex ARM semihosting
8899 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8900
8901 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8902 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8903 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8904 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8905 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8906 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8910 @cindex ARM semihosting
8911 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8912
8913 @example
8914 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8915 @end example
8916
8917 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8918 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8919 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8920 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8924 @cindex ARM semihosting
8925 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8926 status.
8927
8928 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8929 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8930 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8931 debugger.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8935 @cindex ARM semihosting
8936 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8937
8938 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8939 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8940 the value returned by the target.
8941
8942 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8943 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8944 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8945 encountering a break.
8946
8947 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8948 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8949 to the debugger.
8950 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8951 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8952 request or equivalent").
8953
8954 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8955 this option (default: disabled).
8956 @end deffn
8957
8958 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8959 @cindex ARMv4
8960 @cindex ARMv5
8961
8962 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8963 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8964 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8965 variant.
8966
8967 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8968 @cindex ARM7
8969 @cindex ARM9
8970
8971 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8972 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8973 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8974 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8975
8976 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8977 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8978 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8979 instead of breakpoints.
8980 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8981
8982 This should be
8983 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8984 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8985 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8986 @end deffn
8987
8988 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8989 @cindex DCC
8990 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8991 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8992 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8993
8994 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8995 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8996 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8997 @end deffn
8998
8999 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9000 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9001 that don't check completion of the operation.
9002 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9003
9004 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9005 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9006 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9010 @cindex ARM9
9011
9012 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9013 integer processors.
9014 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9015
9016 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9017 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9018 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9019 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9020
9021 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9022 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9023 @cindex vector_catch
9024 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9025 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9026 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9027 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9028 to those hardware vectors.
9029
9030 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9031 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9032 vector catch hardware to intercept
9033 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9034 @option{none} of them,
9035 or a list with one or more of the following:
9036 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9037 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9041 @cindex ARM920T
9042
9043 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9044 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9045 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9046 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9047 and ARM9 commands.
9048
9049 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9050 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9051 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9052 @end deffn
9053
9054 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9055 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9056 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9057 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9058 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9059 (Not all registers can be written.)
9060 @end deffn
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9063 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9067 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9071 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9072
9073 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9074 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9075 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9076 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9077 and ARM9 commands.
9078
9079 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9080 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9081
9082 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9083 Print information about the caches found.
9084 @end deffn
9085
9086 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9087 @cindex ARM966E
9088
9089 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9090 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9091 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9092 and ARM9 commands.
9093
9094 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9095 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9096 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9097 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9098 ARM966E-S TRM.
9099 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9100 as required for BIST support.
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 @subsection XScale specific commands
9104 @cindex XScale
9105
9106 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9107
9108 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9109 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9110 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9111 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9112 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9113 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9114 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9115
9116 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9117 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9118 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9119 the mini-IC.
9120
9121 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9122 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9123 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9124 code layout in memory:
9125 @example
9126 _vectors:
9127 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9128 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9129 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9130 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9131 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9132 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9133 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9134 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9135 .org 0x100
9136 .long real_reset_vector
9137 .long real_ui_handler
9138 .long real_swi_handler
9139 .long real_pf_abort
9140 .long real_data_abort
9141 .long 0 /* unused */
9142 .long real_irq_handler
9143 .long real_fiq_handler
9144 @end example
9145
9146 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9147 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9148 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9149 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9150 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9151 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9152 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9153 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9154 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9155 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9156 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9157 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9158 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9159 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9160 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9161 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9162 software.
9163
9164 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9165 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9166 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9167 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9168
9169 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9170 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9171 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9172 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9173 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9174 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9175 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9176 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9177 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9178
9179 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9180 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9181
9182 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9183 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9184 @end deffn
9185
9186 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9187 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9188 @end deffn
9189
9190 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9191 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9192 @end deffn
9193
9194 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9195 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9196 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9197 @end deffn
9198
9199 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9200 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9204 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9208 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9212 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9213 @end deffn
9214
9215 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9216 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9220 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9221 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9222 and modifying how it is emptied.
9223 @end deffn
9224
9225 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9226 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9227 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9228 The image @var{type} may be one of
9229 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9230 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9231 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9232 @end deffn
9233
9234 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9235 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9236 @cindex vector_catch
9237 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9238 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9239
9240 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9241 @example
9242 0x01 Trap Reset
9243 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9244 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9245 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9246 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9247 0x20 reserved
9248 0x40 Trap IRQ
9249 0x80 Trap FIQ
9250 @end example
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9254 @cindex vector_table
9255
9256 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9257 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9258 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9259 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9260 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9261
9262 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9263
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9267 @cindex ARMv6
9268
9269 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9270 @cindex ARM11
9271
9272 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9273 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9274 which is enabled by default.
9275 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9276 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9277 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9278 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9279 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9280 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9284 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9285 which is enabled by default.
9286 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9287 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9291 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9292 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9293 they are disabled by default.
9294 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9298 @cindex vector_catch
9299 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9300 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9301 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9302
9303 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9304 for certain hardware events.
9305 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9306 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9307 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9311 @cindex ARMv7
9312 @cindex ARMv8
9313
9314 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9315 @cindex Cortex-A
9316
9317 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9318 display information about target caches
9319 @end deffn
9320
9321 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9322 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9323 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9324 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9325 Defaults to 'off'.
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9329 Initialize core debug
9330 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9334 Display/set the current SMP mode
9335 @end deffn
9336
9337 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9338 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9342 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9343 @end deffn
9344
9345 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9346 configure l2x cache
9347 @end deffn
9348
9349 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9350 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9351 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9352 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9353 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9357 @cindex Cortex-R
9358
9359 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9360 Initialize core debug
9361 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9365 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9366 @end deffn
9367
9368
9369 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9370 @cindex tracing
9371 @cindex SWO
9372 @cindex SWV
9373 @cindex TPIU
9374
9375 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9376 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9377 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9378 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9379
9380 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9381 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9382 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9383 which causes quite some confusion.
9384 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9385 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9386
9387 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9388 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9389 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9390
9391 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9392 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9393 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9394 @end deffn
9395
9396 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9397 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9398 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9399 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9400
9401 @itemize @bullet
9402 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9403 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9404 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9405 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9406
9407 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9408 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9409 @end itemize
9410 @end deffn
9411
9412 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9413 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9414 @end deffn
9415
9416 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9417 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9418 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9419 at any time after the initialization, too.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9423 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9424 individually queried, to return its current value.
9425 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9429 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9430 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9431 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9432
9433 @itemize @bullet
9434 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9435 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9436
9437 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9438 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9439
9440 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9441 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9442
9443 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9444 protocol used for trace data:
9445 @itemize @minus
9446 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9447 data bits (default);
9448 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9449 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9450 @end itemize
9451
9452 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9453 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9454 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9455 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9456 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9457 of the TPIU.
9458
9459 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9460 the destination of the trace data:
9461 @itemize @minus
9462 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9463 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9464 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9465 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9466 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9467 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9468 each connected client;
9469 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9470 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9471 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9472 @end itemize
9473
9474 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9475 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9476 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9477 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9478
9479 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9480 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9481 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9482 maximum supported rate automatically.
9483
9484 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9485 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9486 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9487
9488 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9489 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9490 default value is @var{0}.
9491 @end itemize
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9495 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9496 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9497 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9498 data.
9499 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9500 after the @command{init}.
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9504 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9505 @end deffn
9506
9507
9508
9509 Example usage:
9510 @enumerate
9511 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9512 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9513 enough to:
9514 @example
9515 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9516 ...
9517 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9518 ...
9519 @end example
9520 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9521 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9522 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9523 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9524 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9525 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9526 @example
9527 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9528 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9529 @end example
9530 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9531 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9532 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9533 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9534 @example
9535 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9536 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9537 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9538 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9539 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9540 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9541 @end example
9542 @end enumerate
9543
9544 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9545 @cindex tracing
9546 @cindex SWO
9547 @cindex SWV
9548 @cindex ITM
9549 @cindex ETM
9550
9551 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9552 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9553 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9554 @end deffn
9555
9556 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9557 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9561 @cindex Cortex-M
9562
9563 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9564 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9565
9566 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9567 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9568 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9569 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9570 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9571 the step command leaves with the core running.
9572
9573 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9574 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9575 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9576 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9577
9578 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9579 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9580 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9581 does.
9582
9583 Default is @option{auto}.
9584 @end deffn
9585
9586 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9587 @cindex vector_catch
9588 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9589 for certain hardware events.
9590
9591 Parameters request interception of
9592 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9593 @option{none} of them,
9594 or one or more of the following:
9595 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9596 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9597 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9598 @option{irq_err},
9599 @option{state_err},
9600 @option{chk_err}, or
9601 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9602 @option{reset}.
9603 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9604 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9605 are mapped to HardFault.
9606 UsageFault checks for
9607 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9608 must also be explicitly enabled.
9609
9610 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9614 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9615 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9616
9617 @itemize @minus
9618 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9619 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9620 @end itemize
9621
9622 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9623 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9624 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9625 to manually reset the peripherals.
9626 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9627
9628 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9629 instead.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9633 @cindex ARMv8-A
9634 @cindex aarch64
9635
9636 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9637 Display information about target caches
9638 @end deffn
9639
9640 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9641 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9642 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9643 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9644 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9645 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9646 @end deffn
9647
9648 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9649 @cindex disassemble
9650 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9651 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9655 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9656 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9657 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9658 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9662 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9663 @option{on}.
9664 @end deffn
9665
9666 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9667 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9668 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9669 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9670 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9671 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9672 @end deffn
9673
9674 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9675
9676 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9677 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9678
9679 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9680
9681 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9682 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9683 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9684 @end deffn
9685
9686 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9687 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9688 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9689 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9690 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9694
9695 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9696 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9697 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9698 @end deffn
9699
9700 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9701
9702 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9703 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9704 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9705 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9706 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9707 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9708 can be collected.
9709
9710 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9711 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9712 tooling.
9713
9714 @quotation Issues
9715 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9716 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9717 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9718 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9719
9720 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9721 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9722 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9723 software operation on the CPU.
9724 @end quotation
9725
9726 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9727 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9728 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9729 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9730 @end deffn
9731
9732 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9733 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9734 @end deffn
9735
9736 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9737 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9738 control is disabled.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9742 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9743 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9744 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9745
9746 Supported trace formats:
9747 @itemize
9748 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9749 timing to be determined.
9750 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9751 addresses.
9752 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9753 @end itemize
9754 @end deffn
9755
9756 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9757 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9758 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9759 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9760
9761 Supported conditions:
9762 @itemize
9763 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9764 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9765 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9766 instruction matches start data and mask.
9767 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9768 instruction matches start data and mask.
9769 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9770 data and mask.
9771 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9772 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9773 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9774 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9775 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9776 @end itemize
9777 @end deffn
9778
9779 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9780 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9781 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9782 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9783
9784 Supported conditions:
9785 @itemize
9786 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9787 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9788 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9789 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9790 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9791 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9792 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9793 data and mask.
9794 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9795 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9796 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9797 @end itemize
9798 @end deffn
9799
9800 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9801 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9802
9803 Supported triggers:
9804 @itemize
9805 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9806 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9807 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9808 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9809 collection.
9810 @end itemize
9811 @end deffn
9812
9813 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9814
9815 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9816 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9817 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9818 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9819 @end deffn
9820
9821 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9822 Display trace configuration.
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
9826 Display trace collection status.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
9830 Start manual trace collection.
9831 @end deffn
9832
9833 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
9834 Stop manual trace collection.
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9838 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9839 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9840 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9841 @option{size} options using DMA.
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9845 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9846 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9847 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9848 @option{size} options using DMA.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @section Intel Architecture
9852
9853 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9854 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9855 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9856 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9857 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9858 @itemize
9859 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9860 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9861 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9862 @end itemize
9863
9864 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9865 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9866 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9867
9868 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
9869 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9870 @end deffn
9871
9872 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
9873 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
9877 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9878 @end deffn
9879
9880 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
9881 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9882 @end deffn
9883
9884 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
9885 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9886 @end deffn
9887
9888 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
9889 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9890 @end deffn
9891
9892 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9893
9894 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9895 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9896
9897 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9898 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9899 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9900 @end deffn
9901 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9902 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9903
9904 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9905
9906 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9907 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9908 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9909 @end deffn
9910
9911 @subsection Registers commands
9912 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9913 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9914 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9915
9916 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9917
9918 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9919 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9920 and "timer" groups.
9921
9922 @emph{example:}
9923 @example
9924 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9925 @end example
9926
9927
9928 @end deffn
9929 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
9930 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9931
9932 @emph{group} can be "system",
9933 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9934 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9935 @end deffn
9936
9937 @section RISC-V Architecture
9938
9939 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9940 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9941 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9942 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9943 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9944 implement version 0.11.
9945
9946 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9947
9948 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9949 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9950 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9951
9952 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9953
9954 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9955 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9956 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9957
9958 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9959 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9960 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9961 CSRs.
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9965 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9966 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9967 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9968 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9969 This command must be executed before `init`.
9970 @end deffn
9971
9972 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9973 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9974 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9975 @end deffn
9976
9977 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9978 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9979 deasserted.
9980 @end deffn
9981
9982 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9983 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9984 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9985 @end deffn
9986
9987 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9988 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9989 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9990 @end deffn
9991
9992 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
9993 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
9994 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
9995 on physical memory.
9996 @end deffn
9997
9998 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
9999 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10000 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10001 performed on physical memory.
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10005 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10006 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10007 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10008 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10009 race condition problem in your code.
10010
10011 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10012 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10016 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10017 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10018 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10019 values.
10020
10021 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10022 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10023 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10024 @end deffn
10025
10026 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10027 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10028 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10029 @end deffn
10030
10031 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10032 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10033 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10037 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10038 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10039 @end deffn
10040
10041 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10042 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10043 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10044 @end deffn
10045
10046 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10047
10048 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10049 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10050 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10051 @example
10052 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10053 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10054 @end example
10055
10056 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10057 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10061 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10065
10066 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10067 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10068
10069 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10070 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10071 @end deffn
10072
10073 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10074 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10075 @end deffn
10076
10077 @section ARC Architecture
10078 @cindex ARC
10079
10080 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10081 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10082 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10083 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10084 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10085 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10086 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10087 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10088 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10089 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10090 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10091 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10092 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10093 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10094 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10095
10096
10097 @subsection General ARC commands
10098
10099 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10100
10101 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10102 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10103 arguments:
10104
10105 @itemize @bullet
10106
10107 @item @code{-name} name
10108 @*Name of a register.
10109
10110 @item @code{-num} number
10111 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10112
10113 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10114 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10115
10116 @end itemize
10117
10118 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10119
10120 @itemize @bullet
10121
10122 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10123 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10124 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10125 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10126 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10127 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10128
10129 @item @code{-core}
10130 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10131 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10132 spaces.
10133
10134 @item @code{-bcr}
10135 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10136 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10137 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10138 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10139 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10140
10141 @item @code{-type} type_name
10142 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10143 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10144
10145 @item @code{-g}
10146 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10147 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10148 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10149 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10150 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10151
10152 @end itemize
10153
10154 @end deffn
10155
10156 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10157 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10158 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10159 @end deffn
10160
10161 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10162 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10163 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10164 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10165 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10166 startbit endbit}.
10167 @end deffn
10168
10169 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10170 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10171 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10172 @end deffn
10173
10174 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10175 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10176 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10177 @end deffn
10178
10179 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10182 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10183 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10184 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10185
10186 @end deffn
10187
10188 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10189 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10190 registers.
10191 @end deffn
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10194 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10195 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10196 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10197
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10201 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10202 registers.
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @section STM8 Architecture
10206 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10207 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10208
10209 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10210 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10211
10212 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10213 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10214 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10215 @cindex tracing
10216 @cindex libdcc
10217 @cindex DCC
10218 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10219 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10220 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10221 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10222
10223 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10224 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10225 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10226 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10227 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10228 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10229
10230 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10231 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10232 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10233 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10234 The target being debugged may
10235 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10236 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10237 each supported by a command:
10238
10239 @itemize
10240 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10241 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10242 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10243 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10244
10245 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10246 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10247 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10248
10249 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10250 and then displayed at any time.
10251 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10252
10253 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10254 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10255 @end itemize
10256
10257 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10258 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10259 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10260 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10261 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10262 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10263 does the same thing.
10264
10265 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10266 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10267 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10268 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10269 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10270
10271 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10272 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10273 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10274 @end deffn
10275
10276 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10277 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10278 in the order they triggered.
10279 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10280 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10281 history records.
10282 @end deffn
10283
10284 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10285 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10286 they have been triggered.
10287 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10288 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10289 and associates it with that identifier.
10290
10291 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10292 are not related except by this command.
10293 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10294 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10295 @end deffn
10296
10297
10298 @node JTAG Commands
10299 @chapter JTAG Commands
10300 @cindex JTAG Commands
10301 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10302 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10303 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10304 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10305 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10306
10307 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10308 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10309
10310 @itemize @bullet
10311 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10312 devices such as a CPUs.
10313 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10314 standard state machine (in parallel)
10315 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10316 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10317 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10318 while the reading previous ones.
10319 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10320 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10321 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10322 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10323 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10324 registers.
10325 @end itemize
10326
10327 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10328
10329 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10330 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10331 the order of TAP state transitions.
10332 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10333 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10334 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10335 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10336 these commands are not available.
10337
10338 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10339 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10340 that specify the entire register.
10341 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10342 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10343 The return value holds the original value of each
10344 of those fields.
10345
10346 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10347 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10348 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10349 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10350 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10351
10352 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10353 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10354
10355 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10356 in that state.
10357 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10358 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10359 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10360
10361 @quotation Warning
10362 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10363 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10364 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10365 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10366 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10367 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10368 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10369 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10370 @end quotation
10371 @end deffn
10372
10373 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10374 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10375 This may be used for performance tuning.
10376
10377 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10378 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10379 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10380 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10381 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10382 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10383 @end deffn
10384
10385 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10386 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10387 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10388 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10389 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10390 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10391
10392 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10393 in that state.
10394 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10395 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10396 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10397
10398 @quotation Note
10399 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10400 register values, unlike data register values.
10401 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10402 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10403 @end quotation
10404 @end deffn
10405
10406 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10407 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10408 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10409 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10410 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10411 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10412 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10413 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10414 The final state must also be stable.
10415 @end deffn
10416
10417 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10418 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10419 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10420 Instructions often need some time
10421 to execute before they take effect.
10422 @end deffn
10423
10424 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10425 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10426
10427 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10428 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10429 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10430 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10431 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10432 @end deffn
10433
10434 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10435 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10436 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10437 must also be enabled.
10438 Default is enabled.
10439 @end deffn
10440
10441 @section TAP state names
10442 @cindex TAP state names
10443
10444 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10445 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10446 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10447 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10448
10449 @itemize @bullet
10450 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10451 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10452 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10453 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10454 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10455 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10456 through the data register
10457 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10458 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10459 for update or more shifting
10460 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10461 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10462 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10463 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10464 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10465 through the instruction register
10466 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10467 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10468 for update or more shifting
10469 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10470 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10471 @end itemize
10472
10473 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10474 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10475 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10476 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10477
10478 @itemize @bullet
10479 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10480 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10481 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10482 may not be as expected.
10483 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10484 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10485 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10486 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10487 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10488 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10489 @end itemize
10490
10491 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10492 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10493
10494 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10495 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10496 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10497 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10498
10499 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10500 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10501 @cindex SVF
10502
10503 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10504 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10505 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10506 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10507
10508 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10509 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10510 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10511 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10512
10513 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10514 affect their semantics.
10515
10516 Command options:
10517 @itemize @minus
10518 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10519 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10520 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10521 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10522 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10523 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10524 on the real interface;
10525 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10526 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10527 errors.
10528 @end itemize
10529 @end deffn
10530
10531 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10532 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10533 @cindex XSVF
10534
10535 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10536 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10537 Xilinx devices.
10538 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10539 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10540
10541 @quotation Important
10542 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10543 @end quotation
10544
10545 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10546 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10547 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10548 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10549 that TAP.
10550 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10551 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10552 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10553 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10554 @end deffn
10555
10556 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10557 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10558 after building the software.
10559 You may find them useful:
10560
10561 @itemize
10562 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10563 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10564 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10565 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10566 @end itemize
10567
10568 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10569 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10570 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10571 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10572 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10573 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10574 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10575
10576
10577 @node Utility Commands
10578 @chapter Utility Commands
10579 @cindex Utility Commands
10580
10581 @section RAM testing
10582 @cindex RAM testing
10583
10584 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10585 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10586 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10587 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10588 hardware problems.
10589
10590 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10591 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10592 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10593 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10594
10595 Load the memory testing functions with
10596
10597 @example
10598 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10599 @end example
10600
10601 to get access to the following facilities:
10602
10603 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10604 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10605 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10606 @end deffn
10607
10608 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10609 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10610 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10611 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10612 @end deffn
10613
10614 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10615 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10616 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10617 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10621 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10622 @end deffn
10623
10624 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10625 @cindex Firmware recovery
10626
10627 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10628 devices recovery with JTAG.
10629
10630 For quickstart instructions run:
10631 @example
10632 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10633 @end example
10634
10635 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10636 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10637 @cindex GDB
10638 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10639 to debug remote targets.
10640 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10641
10642 @itemize
10643 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10644 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10645 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10646 as shown in this chapter.
10647 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10648 that also will probably need to be configured.
10649 @end itemize
10650
10651 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10652 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10653 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10654 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10655 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10656 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10657
10658 @section Connecting to GDB
10659 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10660 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10661 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10662 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10663 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10664
10665 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10666
10667 @enumerate
10668 @item
10669 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10670 @example
10671 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10672 @end example
10673 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10674
10675 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10676 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10677 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10678
10679 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10680 remote command above that becomes:
10681 @example
10682 tar ext :3333
10683 @end example
10684
10685 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10686 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10687 available through the command:
10688 @example
10689 target remote localhost:3333
10690 @end example
10691
10692 @item
10693 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10694 @example
10695 target extended-remote | \
10696 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10697 @end example
10698 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10699 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10700 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10701 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10702 @end enumerate
10703
10704 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10705 GDB command line.
10706
10707 @section Sample GDB session startup
10708
10709 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10710 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10711 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10712 small ARM program.
10713 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10714 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10715
10716 @example
10717 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10718 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10719 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10720 ...
10721 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10722 ...
10723 (gdb) load
10724 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10725 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10726 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10727 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10728 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10729 (gdb) continue
10730 Continuing.
10731 ...
10732 @end example
10733
10734 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10735 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10736 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10737 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10738
10739 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10740
10741 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10742 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10743 packet size and the device's memory map.
10744 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10745 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10746 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10747
10748 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10749 You may need to set those up by hand.
10750 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10751 something like:
10752
10753 @example
10754 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10755 @end example
10756
10757 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10758
10759 @example
10760 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10761 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10762 @end example
10763
10764 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10765 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10766 do not have such restrictions.
10767
10768 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10769 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10770 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10771 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10772
10773 @section Programming using GDB
10774 @cindex Programming using GDB
10775 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10776
10777 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10778 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10779 @example
10780 gdb_memory_map disable
10781 @end example
10782 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10783 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10784 working area.
10785
10786 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10787 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10788 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10789 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10790
10791 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10792 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10793
10794 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10795 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10796 @example
10797 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10798 @end example
10799
10800 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10801 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10802
10803 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10804 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10805 will be used.
10806
10807 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10808 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10809 @example
10810 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10811 @end example
10812 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10813
10814 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10815 can be used.
10816
10817 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10818 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10819 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10820
10821 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10822 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10823 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10824
10825 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10826 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10827 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10828 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10829 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10830 without any intrusion of the target process.
10831
10832 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10833 Place following command after target configuration:
10834 @example
10835 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10836 @end example
10837
10838 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10839 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10840 @example
10841 gdb_memory_map disable
10842 @end example
10843
10844 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10845 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10846 @example
10847 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10848 @end example
10849
10850 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10851 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10852
10853 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10854 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10855 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10856 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10857
10858 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10859 previously shown variables.
10860
10861 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10862 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10863 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10864 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10865 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10866
10867 @section RTOS Support
10868 @cindex RTOS Support
10869 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10870
10871 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10872 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10873
10874 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10875 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10876 GDB commands.
10877
10878 @* An example setup is below:
10879
10880 @example
10881 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10882 @end example
10883
10884 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10885
10886 Currently supported rtos's include:
10887 @itemize @bullet
10888 @item @option{eCos}
10889 @item @option{ThreadX}
10890 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10891 @item @option{linux}
10892 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10893 @item @option{embKernel}
10894 @item @option{mqx}
10895 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10896 @item @option{nuttx}
10897 @item @option{RIOT}
10898 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10899 @end itemize
10900
10901 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10902 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10903
10904 @table @code
10905 @item eCos symbols
10906 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10907 @item ThreadX symbols
10908 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10909 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10910 @raggedright
10911 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10912 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10913 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10914 @end raggedright
10915 @item linux symbols
10916 init_task.
10917 @item ChibiOS symbols
10918 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10919 @item embKernel symbols
10920 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10921 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10922 @item mqx symbols
10923 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10924 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10925 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
10926 @item nuttx symbols
10927 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
10928 @item RIOT symbols
10929 @raggedright
10930 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
10931 _tcb_name_offset.
10932 @end raggedright
10933 @end table
10934
10935 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10936 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10937
10938 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10939 along with the project:
10940
10941 @table @code
10942 @item FreeRTOS
10943 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10944 @item uC/OS-III
10945 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10946 @end table
10947
10948 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10949 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10950 @cindex SMP
10951 @cindex RTOS
10952 @cindex hwthread
10953 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10954 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10955 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10956 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10957 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10958 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10959 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10960 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10961 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10962
10963 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10964 @quotation Note
10965 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10966 @end quotation
10967
10968 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10969 @itemize @bullet
10970 @item j - smp status request
10971 @item J - smp set request
10972 @end itemize
10973
10974 OpenOCD implements :
10975 @itemize @bullet
10976 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10977 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10978 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10979 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10980 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10981 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10982 @end itemize
10983
10984 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10985 @itemize @bullet
10986 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10987 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10988 @example
10989 set $_core 1
10990 #Jc01 packet is sent
10991 print $_core
10992 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10993 @end example
10994
10995 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10996 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10997
10998 @example
10999 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11000 define toggle0
11001 maint packet Jc0
11002 continue
11003 main packet Jc-1
11004 end
11005 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11006 define toggle1
11007 maint packet Jc1
11008 continue
11009 main packet Jc-1
11010 end
11011 @end example
11012 @end itemize
11013
11014 @node Tcl Scripting API
11015 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11016 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11017 @cindex Tcl scripts
11018 @section API rules
11019
11020 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11021 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11022 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11023
11024 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11025 pair list and lists.
11026
11027 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11028 list.
11029
11030 @example
11031 > set foo(me) Duane
11032 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11033 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11034 > set foo(duck) Donald
11035 @end example
11036
11037 If one does this:
11038
11039 @example
11040 > set foo
11041 @end example
11042
11043 The result is:
11044
11045 @example
11046 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11047 @end example
11048
11049 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11050
11051 @verbatim
11052 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11053 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11054 }
11055 @end verbatim
11056
11057 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11058 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11059
11060 @section Internal low-level Commands
11061
11062 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11063 invoke directly.
11064
11065 @itemize @bullet
11066 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11067
11068 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11069 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11070
11071 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11072 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11073
11074 Return information about the flash banks
11075
11076 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11077
11078 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11079 its execution. Example:
11080
11081 @example
11082 > capture "reset init"
11083 @end example
11084
11085 @end itemize
11086
11087 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11088 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11089 called "flash_banks".
11090
11091 @section Tcl RPC server
11092 @cindex RPC
11093
11094 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11095 commands and receive the results.
11096
11097 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11098 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11099 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11100 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11101 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11102
11103 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11104 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11105 @command{capture} command.
11106
11107 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11108
11109 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11110 @cindex RPC Notifications
11111
11112 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11113 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11114
11115 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11116 in the following format.
11117
11118 @verbatim
11119 type target_event event [event-name]
11120 type target_state state [state-name]
11121 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11122 @end verbatim
11123
11124 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11125 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11126 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11127 Defaults to off.
11128
11129 @end deffn
11130
11131 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11132 @cindex RPC trace output
11133
11134 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11135 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11136
11137 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11138
11139 @verbatim
11140 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11141 @end verbatim
11142
11143 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11144 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11145 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11146 Defaults to off.
11147
11148 See an example application here:
11149 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11150
11151 @end deffn
11152
11153 @node FAQ
11154 @chapter FAQ
11155 @cindex faq
11156 @enumerate
11157 @anchor{faqrtck}
11158 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11159 @cindex RTCK
11160 @cindex adaptive clocking
11161 @*
11162
11163 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11164 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11165 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11166 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11167
11168 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11169 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11170 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11171 @enumerate
11172 @item
11173 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11174 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11175 @item
11176 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11177 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11178 @end enumerate
11179
11180 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11181 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11182 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11183 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11184 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11185 power).
11186
11187 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11188 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11189 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11190 ARM926 scenario).
11191 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11192 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11193 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11194
11195 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11196 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11197 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11198 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11199
11200 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11201
11202 In order to make use of this,
11203 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11204 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11205
11206 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11207 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11208 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11209 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11210 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11211
11212 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11213 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11214 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11215 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11216
11217 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11218 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11219 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11220 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11221 with a CPLD.
11222 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11223 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11224 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11225 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11226 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11227 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11228
11229 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11230
11231 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11232
11233 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11234 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11235 depending on the chips on your board.
11236 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11237 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11238 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11239
11240 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11241 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11242 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11243
11244 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11245 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11246 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11247 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11248
11249 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11250 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11251 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11252 this way.
11253
11254 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11255 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11256 clock rate.
11257 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11258 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11259 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11260
11261 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11262
11263 @example
11264 # Example: 1.234MHz
11265 adapter speed 1234
11266 @end example
11267
11268
11269 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11270
11271 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11272 around Windows filenames.
11273
11274 @example
11275 > echo \a
11276
11277 > echo @{\a@}
11278 \a
11279 > echo "\a"
11280
11281 >
11282 @end example
11283
11284
11285 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11286
11287 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11288 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11289 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11290
11291 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11292 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11293 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11294
11295 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11296 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11297 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11298
11299 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11300
11301 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11302 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11303 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11304 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11305
11306 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11307 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11308 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11309
11310 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11311 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11312
11313 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11314 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11315 memory read caused data abort".
11316
11317 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11318 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11319 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11320 be done, feel free to add this here.
11321
11322 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11323 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11324 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11325 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11326 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11327 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11328 gracefully stops.
11329
11330 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11331 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11332 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11333
11334 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11335 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11336 bytes. Painful...
11337
11338
11339 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11340 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11341
11342 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11343 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11344 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11345 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11346 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11347 reset, everything else should work fine.
11348
11349 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11350 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11351 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11352 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11353
11354 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11355 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11356 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11357 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11358
11359 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11360
11361 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11362 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11363 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11364
11365 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11366 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11367
11368 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11369 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11370 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11371 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11372 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11373 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11374 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11375 clock frequency?
11376
11377 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11378 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11379 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11380 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11381 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11382
11383 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11384
11385 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11386 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11387 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11388 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11389 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11390 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11391 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11392
11393 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11394
11395 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11396 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11397 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11398 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11399
11400 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11401 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11402 particular order?
11403
11404 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11405 the same order used by the hardware.
11406
11407 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11408 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11409 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11410 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11411 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11412 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11413
11414 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11415 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11416 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11417 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11418
11419 @itemize @bullet
11420 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11421 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11422 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11423 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11424 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11425 @end itemize
11426
11427 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11428
11429 @itemize @bullet
11430 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11431 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11432 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11433 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11434 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11435 @end itemize
11436
11437
11438 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11439 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11440 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11441
11442 TODO.
11443
11444 @end enumerate
11445
11446 @node Tcl Crash Course
11447 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11448 @cindex Tcl
11449
11450 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11451 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11452 how the Tcl scripts work.
11453
11454 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11455 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11456 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11457 OpenOCD.
11458
11459 @section Tcl Rule #1
11460 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11461 @enumerate
11462 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11463 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11464 @end enumerate
11465
11466 The Tcl equal is this:
11467
11468 @enumerate
11469 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11470 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11471 @end enumerate
11472
11473 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11474 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11475
11476 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11477 There is a second pair of rules.
11478 @enumerate
11479 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11480 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11481 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11482 in Tcl.
11483 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11484 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11485 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11486 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11487 @end enumerate
11488
11489 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11490 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11491 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11492 Everything is a string}
11493
11494 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11495 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11496 difference is subtle.
11497 @enumerate
11498 @item Parse Time
11499 @item Evaluation Time
11500 @end enumerate
11501
11502 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11503 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11504 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11505
11506 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11507 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11508 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11509 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11510
11511 @itemize @bullet
11512 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11513 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11514 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11515 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11516 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11517 @example
11518 # bash example
11519 X=`date`
11520 echo "The Date is: $X"
11521 # Tcl example
11522 set X [date]
11523 puts "The Date is: $X"
11524 @end example
11525 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11526 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11527 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11528 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11529 is a string}
11530 @example
11531 set x "Dinner"
11532 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11533 @end example
11534 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11535 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11536 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11537 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11538 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11539 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11540 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11541 @end itemize
11542
11543 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11544
11545 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11546
11547 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11548
11549 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11550 the normal way.
11551
11552 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11553 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11554 line is immediately executed.
11555
11556 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11557 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11558
11559 @subsection Command Execution
11560
11561 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11562 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11563 control flow operators.
11564
11565 Commands are executed like this:
11566
11567 @enumerate
11568 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11569 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11570 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11571 @end enumerate
11572
11573 It sort of works like this:
11574 @example
11575 for(;;)@{
11576 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11577
11578 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11579
11580 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11581 @}
11582 @end example
11583
11584 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11585 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11586 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11587 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11588 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11589 ``LookupCommand()''
11590
11591 @subsection The FOR command
11592
11593 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11594 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11595 command just like any other command.
11596
11597 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11598 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11599 are:
11600
11601 @enumerate 0
11602 @item The ascii text 'for'
11603 @item The start text
11604 @item The test expression
11605 @item The next text
11606 @item The body text
11607 @end enumerate
11608
11609 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11610 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11611 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11612 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11613
11614 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11615 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11616
11617 @example
11618 int
11619 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11620 int *argc,
11621 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11622 @end example
11623
11624 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11625 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11626 still operates in the same basic way.
11627
11628 @subsection FOR command implementation
11629
11630 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11631 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11632
11633 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11634
11635 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11636
11637 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11638 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11639 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11640
11641 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11642 expression and returns a value.
11643
11644 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11645 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11646 @example
11647 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11648
11649 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11650
11651 int
11652 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11653 int argc,
11654 char **argv )
11655 @{
11656 if( argc != 5 )@{
11657 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11658 return ERROR;
11659 @}
11660
11661 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11662
11663 // Execute the start statement.
11664 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11665
11666 // Top of loop test
11667 for(;;)@{
11668 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11669 if( i == 0 )
11670 break;
11671
11672 // Execute the body
11673 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11674
11675 // Execute the LOOP part
11676 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11677 @}
11678
11679 // Return no error
11680 SetResult( interp, "" );
11681 return SUCCESS;
11682 @}
11683 @end example
11684
11685 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11686 in the same basic way.
11687
11688 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11689
11690 @subsection source and find commands
11691 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11692 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11693 @*Remember the parsing rules
11694 @enumerate
11695 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11696 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11697 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11698 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11699 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11700 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11701 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11702 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11703 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11704 @end enumerate
11705 @subsection format command
11706 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11707 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11708 @b{sprintf()}.
11709 @b{Example}
11710 @example
11711 set x 6
11712 set y 7
11713 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11714 @end example
11715 @enumerate
11716 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11717 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11718 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11719 @* Refer to Rule #1
11720 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11721 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11722 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11723 @end enumerate
11724 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11725 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11726 @example
11727 #1 Good
11728 proc someproc @{@} @{
11729 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11730 @}
11731 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11732 #2 Good - no variables
11733 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11734 #3 Good Curly Braces
11735 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11736 puts "Time: [date]"
11737 @}
11738 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11739 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11740 @end example
11741 @enumerate
11742 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11743 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11744 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11745 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11746 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11747 command.
11748 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11749 @*There are 4 examples:
11750 @enumerate
11751 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11752 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11753 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11754 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11755 @end enumerate
11756
11757 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11758 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11759 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11760
11761 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11762 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11763 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11764 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11765 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11766 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11767 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11768 @end enumerate
11769 @subsection Global Variables
11770 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11771 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11772 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11773 @example
11774 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11775 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11776 global x #Global variable X
11777 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11778 @}
11779 @end example
11780 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11781 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11782 @example
11783 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11784 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11785 # Create var name
11786 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11787 # Make it a global
11788 global $vn
11789 # Set it.
11790 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11791 @}
11792 @end example
11793 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11794 @example
11795 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11796 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11797 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11798 @}
11799 @end example
11800
11801 @node License
11802 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11803 @include fdl.texi
11804
11805 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11806 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11807 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11808 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11809 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11810 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11811
11812 @printindex cp
11813
11814 @node Command and Driver Index
11815 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11816 @printindex fn
11817
11818 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)